7084 lines
274 KiB
C++
Executable File
7084 lines
274 KiB
C++
Executable File
/* -*- Mode: C++; tab-width: 4; indent-tabs-mode: nil; c-basic-offset: 4 -*- */
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
*
|
|
* DO NOT ALTER OR REMOVE COPYRIGHT NOTICES OR THIS FILE HEADER.
|
|
*
|
|
* Copyright 2000, 2010 Oracle and/or its affiliates.
|
|
*
|
|
* OpenOffice.org - a multi-platform office productivity suite
|
|
*
|
|
* This file is part of OpenOffice.org.
|
|
*
|
|
* OpenOffice.org is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
|
|
* it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License version 3
|
|
* only, as published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
|
*
|
|
* OpenOffice.org is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
|
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
|
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
|
* GNU Lesser General Public License version 3 for more details
|
|
* (a copy is included in the LICENSE file that accompanied this code).
|
|
*
|
|
* You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License
|
|
* version 3 along with OpenOffice.org. If not, see
|
|
* <http://www.openoffice.org/license.html>
|
|
* for a copy of the LGPLv3 License.
|
|
*
|
|
************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
// MARKER(update_precomp.py): autogen include statement, do not remove
|
|
#include "precompiled_sw.hxx"
|
|
|
|
#include <com/sun/star/text/HoriOrientation.hpp>
|
|
#include <hintids.hxx>
|
|
#include <vcl/sound.hxx>
|
|
#include <vcl/lazydelete.hxx>
|
|
#include <tools/poly.hxx>
|
|
#include <svl/svstdarr.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/xoutbmp.hxx>
|
|
#include <sfx2/progress.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/brshitem.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/opaqitem.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/prntitem.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/boxitem.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/shaditem.hxx>
|
|
#include <editeng/ulspitem.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/framelink.hxx>
|
|
#include <vcl/graph.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/svdpagv.hxx>
|
|
#include <tgrditem.hxx>
|
|
#include <switerator.hxx>
|
|
#include <fmtsrnd.hxx>
|
|
#include <fmtclds.hxx>
|
|
#include <tools/shl.hxx>
|
|
#include <comcore.hrc>
|
|
#include <swmodule.hxx>
|
|
#include <rootfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <pagefrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <cntfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <viewsh.hxx>
|
|
#include <section.hxx>
|
|
#include <sectfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <doc.hxx>
|
|
#include <viewimp.hxx>
|
|
#include <dflyobj.hxx>
|
|
#include <flyfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <frmtool.hxx>
|
|
#include <viewopt.hxx>
|
|
#include <dview.hxx>
|
|
#include <dcontact.hxx>
|
|
#include <txtfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <ftnfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <tabfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <rowfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <cellfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <notxtfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <swregion.hxx>
|
|
#include <layact.hxx>
|
|
#include <pagedesc.hxx>
|
|
#include <ptqueue.hxx>
|
|
#include <noteurl.hxx>
|
|
#include <virtoutp.hxx>
|
|
#include <lineinfo.hxx>
|
|
#include <dbg_lay.hxx>
|
|
#include <accessibilityoptions.hxx>
|
|
#include <docsh.hxx>
|
|
#include <swtable.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/svdogrp.hxx>
|
|
#include <sortedobjs.hxx>
|
|
#include <EnhancedPDFExportHelper.hxx>
|
|
#include <bodyfrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <hffrm.hxx>
|
|
#include <colfrm.hxx>
|
|
// <--
|
|
// --> OD #i76669#
|
|
#include <svx/sdr/contact/viewobjectcontactredirector.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/sdr/contact/viewobjectcontact.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/sdr/contact/viewcontact.hxx>
|
|
// <--
|
|
|
|
#include <ndole.hxx>
|
|
#include <svtools/chartprettypainter.hxx>
|
|
#include <PostItMgr.hxx>
|
|
#include <tools/color.hxx>
|
|
#include <vcl/svapp.hxx>
|
|
|
|
#define COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE RGB_COLORDATA(230,230,230)
|
|
#define COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_BORDER RGB_COLORDATA(200,200,200)
|
|
#define COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_SCROLLAREA RGB_COLORDATA(230,230,220)
|
|
|
|
#include <svtools/borderhelper.hxx>
|
|
|
|
#include "pagefrm.hrc"
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/geometry/viewinformation2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/processor2d/baseprocessor2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/polygonprimitive2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/polypolygonprimitive2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/borderlineprimitive2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/discreteshadowprimitive2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/textprimitive2d.hxx>
|
|
#include <drawinglayer/primitive2d/textlayoutdevice.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/sdr/contact/objectcontacttools.hxx>
|
|
#include <svx/unoapi.hxx>
|
|
#include <basegfx/matrix/b2dhommatrix.hxx>
|
|
#include <basegfx/matrix/b2dhommatrixtools.hxx>
|
|
#include <basegfx/polygon/b2dpolygon.hxx>
|
|
#include <basegfx/color/bcolortools.hxx>
|
|
|
|
#include <algorithm>
|
|
#include <wrtsh.hxx>
|
|
#include <edtwin.hxx>
|
|
#include <view.hxx>
|
|
|
|
using namespace ::editeng;
|
|
using namespace ::com::sun::star;
|
|
|
|
#define GETOBJSHELL() ((SfxObjectShell*)rSh.GetDoc()->GetDocShell())
|
|
|
|
//Tabellenhilfslinien an?
|
|
#define IS_SUBS_TABLE \
|
|
(pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsTable() && \
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPagePreview()&&\
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsReadonly()&&\
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsFormView() &&\
|
|
SwViewOption::IsTableBoundaries())
|
|
//sonstige Hilfslinien an?
|
|
#define IS_SUBS (!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPagePreview() && \
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsReadonly() && \
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsFormView() &&\
|
|
SwViewOption::IsDocBoundaries())
|
|
//Hilfslinien fuer Bereiche
|
|
#define IS_SUBS_SECTION (!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPagePreview() && \
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsReadonly()&&\
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsFormView() &&\
|
|
SwViewOption::IsSectionBoundaries())
|
|
#define IS_SUBS_FLYS (!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPagePreview() && \
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsReadonly()&&\
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsFormView() &&\
|
|
SwViewOption::IsObjectBoundaries())
|
|
|
|
#define SW_MAXBORDERCACHE 20
|
|
|
|
//Klassendeklarationen. Hier weil sie eben nur in diesem File benoetigt
|
|
//werden.
|
|
|
|
#define SUBCOL_PAGE 0x01 //Helplines of the page
|
|
#define SUBCOL_TAB 0x08 //Helplines inside tables
|
|
#define SUBCOL_FLY 0x10 //Helplines inside fly frames
|
|
#define SUBCOL_SECT 0x20 //Helplines inside sections
|
|
|
|
// Classes collecting the border lines and help lines
|
|
class SwLineRect : public SwRect
|
|
{
|
|
Color aColor;
|
|
SvxBorderStyle nStyle;
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pTab;
|
|
sal_uInt8 nSubColor; //Hilfslinien einfaerben
|
|
sal_Bool bPainted; //schon gepaintet?
|
|
sal_uInt8 nLock; //Um die Linien zum Hell-Layer abzugrenzen.
|
|
public:
|
|
SwLineRect( const SwRect &rRect, const Color *pCol, const SvxBorderStyle nStyle,
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pT , const sal_uInt8 nSCol );
|
|
|
|
const Color *GetColor() const { return &aColor;}
|
|
SvxBorderStyle GetStyle() const { return nStyle; }
|
|
const SwTabFrm *GetTab() const { return pTab; }
|
|
void SetPainted() { bPainted = sal_True; }
|
|
void Lock( sal_Bool bLock ) { if ( bLock )
|
|
++nLock;
|
|
else if ( nLock )
|
|
--nLock;
|
|
}
|
|
sal_Bool IsPainted() const { return bPainted; }
|
|
sal_Bool IsLocked() const { return nLock != 0; }
|
|
sal_uInt8 GetSubColor() const { return nSubColor;}
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool MakeUnion( const SwRect &rRect );
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
SV_DECL_VARARR( SwLRects, SwLineRect, 100, 100 )
|
|
|
|
class SwLineRects : public SwLRects
|
|
{
|
|
sal_uInt16 nLastCount; //unuetze Durchlaeufe im PaintLines verhindern.
|
|
public:
|
|
SwLineRects() : nLastCount( 0 ) {}
|
|
void AddLineRect( const SwRect& rRect, const Color *pColor, const SvxBorderStyle nStyle,
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pTab, const sal_uInt8 nSCol );
|
|
void ConnectEdges( OutputDevice *pOut );
|
|
void PaintLines ( OutputDevice *pOut );
|
|
void LockLines( sal_Bool bLock );
|
|
|
|
sal_uInt16 Free() const { return nFree; }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
class SwSubsRects : public SwLineRects
|
|
{
|
|
void RemoveSuperfluousSubsidiaryLines( const SwLineRects &rRects ); //;-)
|
|
public:
|
|
void PaintSubsidiary( OutputDevice *pOut, const SwLineRects *pRects );
|
|
|
|
inline void Ins( const SwRect &rRect, const sal_uInt8 nSCol );
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
//----------------- End of classes for border lines ----------------------
|
|
|
|
static ViewShell *pGlobalShell = 0;
|
|
|
|
//Wenn vom Fly ein Metafile abgezogen wird, so soll nur der FlyInhalt und vor
|
|
//nur hintergrund vom FlyInhalt gepaintet werden.
|
|
static sal_Bool bFlyMetafile = sal_False;
|
|
static OutputDevice *pFlyMetafileOut = 0;
|
|
|
|
//Die Retouche fuer Durchsichtige Flys wird vom Hintergrund der Flys
|
|
//erledigt. Dabei darf der Fly selbst natuerlich nicht ausgespart werden.
|
|
//siehe PaintBackground und lcl_SubtractFlys()
|
|
static SwFlyFrm *pRetoucheFly = 0;
|
|
static SwFlyFrm *pRetoucheFly2 = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Sizes of a pixel and the corresponding halves. Will be reset when
|
|
// entering SwRootFrm::Paint
|
|
static long nPixelSzW = 0, nPixelSzH = 0;
|
|
static long nHalfPixelSzW = 0, nHalfPixelSzH = 0;
|
|
static long nMinDistPixelW = 0, nMinDistPixelH = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Current zoom factor
|
|
static double aScaleX = 1.0;
|
|
static double aScaleY = 1.0;
|
|
static double aMinDistScale = 0.73;
|
|
static double aEdgeScale = 0.5;
|
|
|
|
// The borders will be collected in pLines during the Paint and later
|
|
// possibly merge them.
|
|
// The help lines will be collected and merged in pSubsLines. These will
|
|
// be compared with pLines before the work in order to avoid help lines
|
|
// to hide borders.
|
|
// bTablines is sal_True during the Paint of a table.
|
|
static SwLineRects *pLines = 0;
|
|
static SwSubsRects *pSubsLines = 0;
|
|
// global variable for sub-lines of body, header, footer, section and footnote frames.
|
|
static SwSubsRects *pSpecSubsLines = 0;
|
|
|
|
static SfxProgress *pProgress = 0;
|
|
|
|
static SwFlyFrm *pFlyOnlyDraw = 0;
|
|
|
|
//Damit die Flys auch fuer den Hack richtig gepaintet werden koennen.
|
|
static sal_Bool bTableHack = sal_False;
|
|
|
|
//Um das teure Ermitteln der RetoucheColor zu optimieren
|
|
Color aGlobalRetoucheColor;
|
|
|
|
// Set borders alignment statics.
|
|
// adjustment for 'small' twip-to-pixel relations:
|
|
// For 'small' twip-to-pixel relations (less then 2:1)
|
|
// values of <nHalfPixelSzW> and <nHalfPixelSzH> are set to ZERO.
|
|
void SwCalcPixStatics( OutputDevice *pOut )
|
|
{
|
|
// determine 'small' twip-to-pixel relation
|
|
sal_Bool bSmallTwipToPxRelW = sal_False;
|
|
sal_Bool bSmallTwipToPxRelH = sal_False;
|
|
{
|
|
Size aCheckTwipToPxRelSz( pOut->PixelToLogic( Size( 100, 100 )) );
|
|
if ( (aCheckTwipToPxRelSz.Width()/100.0) < 2.0 )
|
|
{
|
|
bSmallTwipToPxRelW = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( (aCheckTwipToPxRelSz.Height()/100.0) < 2.0 )
|
|
{
|
|
bSmallTwipToPxRelH = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Size aSz( pOut->PixelToLogic( Size( 1,1 )) );
|
|
|
|
nPixelSzW = aSz.Width();
|
|
if( !nPixelSzW )
|
|
nPixelSzW = 1;
|
|
nPixelSzH = aSz.Height();
|
|
if( !nPixelSzH )
|
|
nPixelSzH = 1;
|
|
|
|
// consider 'small' twip-to-pixel relations
|
|
if ( !bSmallTwipToPxRelW )
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfPixelSzW = nPixelSzW / 2 + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfPixelSzW = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
// consider 'small' twip-to-pixel relations
|
|
if ( !bSmallTwipToPxRelH )
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfPixelSzH = nPixelSzH / 2 + 1;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfPixelSzH = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
nMinDistPixelW = nPixelSzW * 2 + 1;
|
|
nMinDistPixelH = nPixelSzH * 2 + 1;
|
|
|
|
const MapMode &rMap = pOut->GetMapMode();
|
|
aScaleX = rMap.GetScaleX();
|
|
aScaleY = rMap.GetScaleY();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//Zum Sichern der statics, damit das Paint (quasi) reentrant wird.
|
|
class SwSavePaintStatics
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Bool bSFlyMetafile,
|
|
bSPageOnly;
|
|
ViewShell *pSGlobalShell;
|
|
OutputDevice *pSFlyMetafileOut;
|
|
SwFlyFrm *pSRetoucheFly,
|
|
*pSRetoucheFly2,
|
|
*pSFlyOnlyDraw;
|
|
SwLineRects *pSLines;
|
|
SwSubsRects *pSSubsLines;
|
|
SwSubsRects* pSSpecSubsLines;
|
|
SfxProgress *pSProgress;
|
|
long nSPixelSzW,
|
|
nSPixelSzH,
|
|
nSHalfPixelSzW,
|
|
nSHalfPixelSzH,
|
|
nSMinDistPixelW,
|
|
nSMinDistPixelH;
|
|
Color aSGlobalRetoucheColor;
|
|
double aSScaleX,
|
|
aSScaleY;
|
|
public:
|
|
SwSavePaintStatics();
|
|
~SwSavePaintStatics();
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
SwSavePaintStatics::SwSavePaintStatics() :
|
|
bSFlyMetafile ( bFlyMetafile ),
|
|
pSGlobalShell ( pGlobalShell ),
|
|
pSFlyMetafileOut ( pFlyMetafileOut ),
|
|
pSRetoucheFly ( pRetoucheFly ),
|
|
pSRetoucheFly2 ( pRetoucheFly2 ),
|
|
pSFlyOnlyDraw ( pFlyOnlyDraw ),
|
|
pSLines ( pLines ),
|
|
pSSubsLines ( pSubsLines ),
|
|
pSSpecSubsLines ( pSpecSubsLines ),
|
|
pSProgress ( pProgress ),
|
|
nSPixelSzW ( nPixelSzW ),
|
|
nSPixelSzH ( nPixelSzH ),
|
|
nSHalfPixelSzW ( nHalfPixelSzW ),
|
|
nSHalfPixelSzH ( nHalfPixelSzH ),
|
|
nSMinDistPixelW ( nMinDistPixelW ),
|
|
nSMinDistPixelH ( nMinDistPixelH ),
|
|
aSGlobalRetoucheColor( aGlobalRetoucheColor ),
|
|
aSScaleX ( aScaleX ),
|
|
aSScaleY ( aScaleY )
|
|
{
|
|
bFlyMetafile = sal_False;
|
|
pFlyMetafileOut = 0;
|
|
pRetoucheFly = 0;
|
|
pRetoucheFly2 = 0;
|
|
nPixelSzW = nPixelSzH =
|
|
nHalfPixelSzW = nHalfPixelSzH =
|
|
nMinDistPixelW = nMinDistPixelH = 0;
|
|
aScaleX = aScaleY = 1.0;
|
|
aMinDistScale = 0.73;
|
|
aEdgeScale = 0.5;
|
|
pLines = 0;
|
|
pSubsLines = 0;
|
|
pSpecSubsLines = 0L;
|
|
pProgress = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwSavePaintStatics::~SwSavePaintStatics()
|
|
{
|
|
pGlobalShell = pSGlobalShell;
|
|
bFlyMetafile = bSFlyMetafile;
|
|
pFlyMetafileOut = pSFlyMetafileOut;
|
|
pRetoucheFly = pSRetoucheFly;
|
|
pRetoucheFly2 = pSRetoucheFly2;
|
|
pFlyOnlyDraw = pSFlyOnlyDraw;
|
|
pLines = pSLines;
|
|
pSubsLines = pSSubsLines;
|
|
pSpecSubsLines = pSSpecSubsLines;
|
|
pProgress = pSProgress;
|
|
nPixelSzW = nSPixelSzW;
|
|
nPixelSzH = nSPixelSzH;
|
|
nHalfPixelSzW = nSHalfPixelSzW;
|
|
nHalfPixelSzH = nSHalfPixelSzH;
|
|
nMinDistPixelW = nSMinDistPixelW;
|
|
nMinDistPixelH = nSMinDistPixelH;
|
|
aGlobalRetoucheColor = aSGlobalRetoucheColor;
|
|
aScaleX = aSScaleX;
|
|
aScaleY = aSScaleY;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//----------------- Implementation for the table borders --------------
|
|
|
|
SV_IMPL_VARARR( SwLRects, SwLineRect );
|
|
|
|
SwLineRect::SwLineRect( const SwRect &rRect, const Color *pCol, const SvxBorderStyle nStyl,
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pT, const sal_uInt8 nSCol ) :
|
|
SwRect( rRect ),
|
|
nStyle( nStyl ),
|
|
pTab( pT ),
|
|
nSubColor( nSCol ),
|
|
bPainted( sal_False ),
|
|
nLock( 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pCol != NULL )
|
|
aColor = *pCol;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool SwLineRect::MakeUnion( const SwRect &rRect )
|
|
{
|
|
// It has already been tested outside, whether the rectangles have
|
|
// the same orientation (horizontal or vertical), color, etc.
|
|
if ( Height() > Width() ) //Vertical line
|
|
{
|
|
if ( Left() == rRect.Left() && Width() == rRect.Width() )
|
|
{
|
|
// Merge when there is no gap between the lines
|
|
const long nAdd = nPixelSzW + nHalfPixelSzW;
|
|
if ( Bottom() + nAdd >= rRect.Top() &&
|
|
Top() - nAdd <= rRect.Bottom() )
|
|
{
|
|
Bottom( Max( Bottom(), rRect.Bottom() ) );
|
|
Top ( Min( Top(), rRect.Top() ) );
|
|
return sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( Top() == rRect.Top() && Height() == rRect.Height() )
|
|
{
|
|
// Merge when there is no gap between the lines
|
|
const long nAdd = nPixelSzW + nHalfPixelSzW;
|
|
if ( Right() + nAdd >= rRect.Left() &&
|
|
Left() - nAdd <= rRect.Right() )
|
|
{
|
|
Right( Max( Right(), rRect.Right() ) );
|
|
Left ( Min( Left(), rRect.Left() ) );
|
|
return sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLineRects::AddLineRect( const SwRect &rRect, const Color *pCol, const SvxBorderStyle nStyle,
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pTab, const sal_uInt8 nSCol )
|
|
{
|
|
//Rueckwaerts durch, weil Linien die zusammengefasst werden koennen i.d.R.
|
|
//im gleichen Kontext gepaintet werden.
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = Count(); i ; )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLRect = operator[](--i);
|
|
// Test for the orientation, color, table
|
|
if ( rLRect.GetTab() == pTab &&
|
|
!rLRect.IsPainted() && rLRect.GetSubColor() == nSCol &&
|
|
(rLRect.Height() > rLRect.Width()) == (rRect.Height() > rRect.Width()) &&
|
|
((!rLRect.GetColor() && !pCol) ||
|
|
(rLRect.GetColor() && pCol && *rLRect.GetColor() == *pCol)) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rLRect.MakeUnion( rRect ) )
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( rRect, pCol, nStyle, pTab, nSCol ), Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLineRects::ConnectEdges( OutputDevice *pOut )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pOut->GetOutDevType() != OUTDEV_PRINTER )
|
|
{
|
|
// I'm not doing anything for a too small zoom
|
|
if ( aScaleX < aEdgeScale || aScaleY < aEdgeScale )
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static const long nAdd = 20;
|
|
|
|
SvPtrarr aCheck( 64, 64 );
|
|
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < (int)Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rL1 = operator[](sal_uInt16(i));
|
|
if ( !rL1.GetTab() || rL1.IsPainted() || rL1.IsLocked() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
aCheck.Remove( 0, aCheck.Count() );
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bVert = rL1.Height() > rL1.Width();
|
|
long nL1a, nL1b, nL1c, nL1d;
|
|
|
|
if ( bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
nL1a = rL1.Top(); nL1b = rL1.Left();
|
|
nL1c = rL1.Right(); nL1d = rL1.Bottom();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nL1a = rL1.Left(); nL1b = rL1.Top();
|
|
nL1c = rL1.Bottom(); nL1d = rL1.Right();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Collect all lines to possibly link with i1
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i2 = 0; i2 < Count(); ++i2 )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rL2 = operator[](i2);
|
|
if ( rL2.GetTab() != rL1.GetTab() ||
|
|
rL2.IsPainted() ||
|
|
rL2.IsLocked() ||
|
|
(bVert == (rL2.Height() > rL2.Width())) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
long nL2a, nL2b, nL2c, nL2d;
|
|
if ( bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
nL2a = rL2.Top(); nL2b = rL2.Left();
|
|
nL2c = rL2.Right(); nL2d = rL2.Bottom();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nL2a = rL2.Left(); nL2b = rL2.Top();
|
|
nL2c = rL2.Bottom(); nL2d = rL2.Right();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( (nL1a - nAdd < nL2d && nL1d + nAdd > nL2a) &&
|
|
((nL1b > nL2b && nL1c < nL2c) ||
|
|
(nL1c >= nL2c && nL1b - nAdd < nL2c) ||
|
|
(nL1b <= nL2b && nL1c + nAdd > nL2b)) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect *pMSC = &rL2;
|
|
aCheck.Insert( pMSC, aCheck.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( aCheck.Count() < 2 )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bRemove = sal_False;
|
|
|
|
// For each line test all following ones.
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 k = 0; !bRemove && k < aCheck.Count(); ++k )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rR1 = (SwLineRect&)*(SwLineRect*)aCheck[k];
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 k2 = k+1; !bRemove && k2 < aCheck.Count(); ++k2 )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rR2 = (SwLineRect&)*(SwLineRect*)aCheck[k2];
|
|
if ( bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect *pLA = 0;
|
|
SwLineRect *pLB = 0;
|
|
if ( rR1.Top() < rR2.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLA = &rR1; pLB = &rR2;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( rR1.Top() > rR2.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLA = &rR2; pLB = &rR1;
|
|
}
|
|
// are k1 and k2 describing a double line?
|
|
if ( pLA && pLA->Bottom() + 60 > pLB->Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rL1.Top() < pLA->Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rL1.Bottom() == pLA->Bottom() )
|
|
continue; //Small mistake (where?)
|
|
|
|
SwRect aIns( rL1 );
|
|
aIns.Bottom( pLA->Bottom() );
|
|
if ( !rL1.IsInside( aIns ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
const sal_uInt16 nTmpFree = Free();
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aIns, rL1.GetColor(), SOLID,
|
|
rL1.GetTab(), SUBCOL_TAB ), Count() );
|
|
if ( !nTmpFree )
|
|
{
|
|
--i;
|
|
k = aCheck.Count();
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rL1.Bottom() > pLB->Bottom() )
|
|
rL1.Top( pLB->Top() ); // extend i1 on the top
|
|
else
|
|
bRemove = sal_True; //stopping, remove i1
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect *pLA = 0;
|
|
SwLineRect *pLB = 0;
|
|
if ( rR1.Left() < rR2.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLA = &rR1; pLB = &rR2;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( rR1.Left() > rR2.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLA = &rR2; pLB = &rR1;
|
|
}
|
|
// Is it double line?
|
|
if ( pLA && pLA->Right() + 60 > pLB->Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rL1.Left() < pLA->Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rL1.Right() == pLA->Right() )
|
|
continue; //small error
|
|
|
|
SwRect aIns( rL1 );
|
|
aIns.Right( pLA->Right() );
|
|
if ( !rL1.IsInside( aIns ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
const sal_uInt16 nTmpFree = Free();
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aIns, rL1.GetColor(), SOLID,
|
|
rL1.GetTab(), SUBCOL_TAB ), Count() );
|
|
if ( !nTmpFree )
|
|
{
|
|
--i;
|
|
k = aCheck.Count();
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( rL1.Right() > pLB->Right() )
|
|
rL1.Left( pLB->Left() );
|
|
else
|
|
bRemove = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bRemove )
|
|
{
|
|
Remove( static_cast<sal_uInt16>(i), 1 );
|
|
--i; //Leave none!
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
inline void SwSubsRects::Ins( const SwRect &rRect, const sal_uInt8 nSCol )
|
|
{
|
|
// Lines that are shorted than the largest line width won't be inserted
|
|
if ( rRect.Height() > DEF_LINE_WIDTH_4 || rRect.Width() > DEF_LINE_WIDTH_4 )
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( rRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSCol ), Count());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwSubsRects::RemoveSuperfluousSubsidiaryLines( const SwLineRects &rRects )
|
|
{
|
|
// All help lines that are covered by any border will be removed or split
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
// get a copy instead of a reference, because an <insert> may destroy
|
|
// the object due to a necessary array resize.
|
|
const SwLineRect aSubsLineRect = SwLineRect( operator[](i) );
|
|
|
|
// add condition <aSubsLineRect.IsLocked()> in order to consider only
|
|
// border lines, which are *not* locked.
|
|
if ( aSubsLineRect.IsPainted() ||
|
|
aSubsLineRect.IsLocked() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
const bool bVerticalSubs = aSubsLineRect.Height() > aSubsLineRect.Width();
|
|
SwRect aSubsRect( aSubsLineRect );
|
|
if ( bVerticalSubs )
|
|
{
|
|
aSubsRect.Left ( aSubsRect.Left() - (nPixelSzW+nHalfPixelSzW) );
|
|
aSubsRect.Right ( aSubsRect.Right() + (nPixelSzW+nHalfPixelSzW) );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aSubsRect.Top ( aSubsRect.Top() - (nPixelSzH+nHalfPixelSzH) );
|
|
aSubsRect.Bottom( aSubsRect.Bottom() + (nPixelSzH+nHalfPixelSzH) );
|
|
}
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 k = 0; k < rRects.Count(); ++k )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLine = rRects[k];
|
|
|
|
// do *not* consider painted or locked border lines.
|
|
// #i1837# - locked border lines have to be considered.
|
|
if ( rLine.IsLocked () )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( !bVerticalSubs == ( rLine.Height() > rLine.Width() ) ) //same direction?
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( aSubsRect.IsOver( rLine ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bVerticalSubs ) // Vertical?
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aSubsRect.Left() <= rLine.Right() &&
|
|
aSubsRect.Right() >= rLine.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
long nTmp = rLine.Top()-(nPixelSzH+1);
|
|
if ( aSubsLineRect.Top() < nTmp )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aNewSubsRect( aSubsLineRect );
|
|
aNewSubsRect.Bottom( nTmp );
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aNewSubsRect, 0, aSubsLineRect.GetStyle(), 0,
|
|
aSubsLineRect.GetSubColor() ), Count());
|
|
}
|
|
nTmp = rLine.Bottom()+nPixelSzH+1;
|
|
if ( aSubsLineRect.Bottom() > nTmp )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aNewSubsRect( aSubsLineRect );
|
|
aNewSubsRect.Top( nTmp );
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aNewSubsRect, 0, aSubsLineRect.GetStyle(), 0,
|
|
aSubsLineRect.GetSubColor() ), Count());
|
|
}
|
|
Remove( i, 1 );
|
|
--i;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else //Horizontal
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aSubsRect.Top() <= rLine.Bottom() &&
|
|
aSubsRect.Bottom() >= rLine.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
long nTmp = rLine.Left()-(nPixelSzW+1);
|
|
if ( aSubsLineRect.Left() < nTmp )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aNewSubsRect( aSubsLineRect );
|
|
aNewSubsRect.Right( nTmp );
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aNewSubsRect, 0, aSubsLineRect.GetStyle(), 0,
|
|
aSubsLineRect.GetSubColor() ), Count());
|
|
}
|
|
nTmp = rLine.Right()+nPixelSzW+1;
|
|
if ( aSubsLineRect.Right() > nTmp )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aNewSubsRect( aSubsLineRect );
|
|
aNewSubsRect.Left( nTmp );
|
|
Insert( SwLineRect( aNewSubsRect, 0, aSubsLineRect.GetStyle(), 0,
|
|
aSubsLineRect.GetSubColor() ), Count());
|
|
}
|
|
Remove( i, 1 );
|
|
--i;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLineRects::LockLines( sal_Bool bLock )
|
|
{
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
operator[](i).Lock( bLock );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void lcl_DrawDashedRect( OutputDevice * pOut, SwLineRect & rLRect )
|
|
{
|
|
double nHalfLWidth = rLRect.Height( );
|
|
if ( nHalfLWidth > 1 )
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfLWidth = nHalfLWidth / 2;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfLWidth = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long startX = rLRect.Left( );
|
|
long startY = rLRect.Top( ) + static_cast<long>(nHalfLWidth);
|
|
long endX = rLRect.Left( ) + rLRect.Width( );
|
|
long endY = rLRect.Top( ) + static_cast<long>(nHalfLWidth);
|
|
|
|
if ( rLRect.Height( ) > rLRect.Width( ) )
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfLWidth = rLRect.Width( );
|
|
if ( nHalfLWidth > 1 )
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfLWidth = nHalfLWidth / 2;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nHalfLWidth = 1;
|
|
}
|
|
startX = rLRect.Left( ) + static_cast<long>(nHalfLWidth);
|
|
startY = rLRect.Top( );
|
|
endX = rLRect.Left( ) + static_cast<long>(nHalfLWidth);
|
|
endY = rLRect.Top( ) + rLRect.Height( );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
svtools::DrawLine( *pOut, Point( startX, startY ), Point( endX, endY ),
|
|
sal_uInt32( nHalfLWidth * 2 ), rLRect.GetStyle( ) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLineRects::PaintLines( OutputDevice *pOut )
|
|
{
|
|
// Paint the borders. Sadly two passes are needed.
|
|
// Once for the inside and once for the outside edges of tables
|
|
if ( Count() != nLastCount )
|
|
{
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *pOut );
|
|
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_FILLCOLOR|PUSH_LINECOLOR );
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor();
|
|
pOut->SetLineColor();
|
|
ConnectEdges( pOut );
|
|
const Color *pLast = 0;
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bPaint2nd = sal_False;
|
|
sal_uInt16 nMinCount = Count();
|
|
sal_uInt16 i;
|
|
|
|
for ( i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLRect = operator[](i);
|
|
|
|
if ( rLRect.IsPainted() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( rLRect.IsLocked() )
|
|
{
|
|
nMinCount = Min( nMinCount, i );
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Paint it now or in the second pass?
|
|
sal_Bool bPaint = sal_True;
|
|
if ( rLRect.GetTab() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rLRect.Height() > rLRect.Width() )
|
|
{
|
|
// Vertical edge, overlapping with the table edge?
|
|
SwTwips nLLeft = rLRect.Left() - 30,
|
|
nLRight = rLRect.Right() + 30,
|
|
nTLeft = rLRect.GetTab()->Frm().Left() + rLRect.GetTab()->Prt().Left(),
|
|
nTRight = rLRect.GetTab()->Frm().Left() + rLRect.GetTab()->Prt().Right();
|
|
if ( (nTLeft >= nLLeft && nTLeft <= nLRight) ||
|
|
(nTRight>= nLLeft && nTRight<= nLRight) )
|
|
bPaint = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Horizontal edge, overlapping with the table edge?
|
|
SwTwips nLTop = rLRect.Top() - 30,
|
|
nLBottom = rLRect.Bottom() + 30,
|
|
nTTop = rLRect.GetTab()->Frm().Top() + rLRect.GetTab()->Prt().Top(),
|
|
nTBottom = rLRect.GetTab()->Frm().Top() + rLRect.GetTab()->Prt().Bottom();
|
|
if ( (nTTop >= nLTop && nTTop <= nLBottom) ||
|
|
(nTBottom >= nLTop && nTBottom <= nLBottom) )
|
|
bPaint = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bPaint )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pLast || *pLast != *rLRect.GetColor() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLast = rLRect.GetColor();
|
|
|
|
sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = pOut->GetDrawMode();
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
|
|
pOut->SetLineColor( *pLast );
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor( *pLast );
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if( !rLRect.IsEmpty() )
|
|
lcl_DrawDashedRect( pOut, rLRect );
|
|
rLRect.SetPainted();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bPaint2nd = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bPaint2nd )
|
|
for ( i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLRect = operator[](i);
|
|
if ( rLRect.IsPainted() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( rLRect.IsLocked() )
|
|
{
|
|
nMinCount = Min( nMinCount, i );
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !pLast || *pLast != *rLRect.GetColor() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLast = rLRect.GetColor();
|
|
|
|
sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = pOut->GetDrawMode();
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor( *pLast );
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
}
|
|
if( !rLRect.IsEmpty() )
|
|
lcl_DrawDashedRect( pOut, rLRect );
|
|
rLRect.SetPainted();
|
|
}
|
|
nLastCount = nMinCount;
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwSubsRects::PaintSubsidiary( OutputDevice *pOut,
|
|
const SwLineRects *pRects )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( Count() )
|
|
{
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *pOut );
|
|
|
|
// Remove all help line that are almost covered (tables)
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLi = operator[](i);
|
|
const bool bVerticalSubs = rLi.Height() > rLi.Width();
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 k = i+1; k < Count(); ++k )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLk = operator[](k);
|
|
if ( rLi.SSize() == rLk.SSize() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bVerticalSubs == ( rLk.Height() > rLk.Width() ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bVerticalSubs )
|
|
{
|
|
long nLi = rLi.Right();
|
|
long nLk = rLk.Right();
|
|
if ( rLi.Top() == rLk.Top() &&
|
|
((nLi < rLk.Left() && nLi+21 > rLk.Left()) ||
|
|
(nLk < rLi.Left() && nLk+21 > rLi.Left())))
|
|
{
|
|
Remove( k, 1 );
|
|
// don't continue with inner loop any more:
|
|
// the array may shrink!
|
|
--i; k = Count();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
long nLi = rLi.Bottom();
|
|
long nLk = rLk.Bottom();
|
|
if ( rLi.Left() == rLk.Left() &&
|
|
((nLi < rLk.Top() && nLi+21 > rLk.Top()) ||
|
|
(nLk < rLi.Top() && nLk+21 > rLi.Top())))
|
|
{
|
|
Remove( k, 1 );
|
|
--i; k = Count();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( pRects && pRects->Count() )
|
|
RemoveSuperfluousSubsidiaryLines( *pRects );
|
|
|
|
if ( Count() )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_FILLCOLOR|PUSH_LINECOLOR );
|
|
pOut->SetLineColor();
|
|
|
|
// Reset draw mode in high contrast mode in order to get fill color
|
|
// set at output device. Recover draw mode after draw of lines.
|
|
// Necessary for the subsidiary lines painted by the fly frames.
|
|
sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = pOut->GetDrawMode();
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineRect &rLRect = operator[](i);
|
|
// Add condition <!rLRect.IsLocked()> to prevent paint of locked subsidiary lines.
|
|
if ( !rLRect.IsPainted() &&
|
|
!rLRect.IsLocked() )
|
|
{
|
|
const Color *pCol = 0;
|
|
switch ( rLRect.GetSubColor() )
|
|
{
|
|
case SUBCOL_PAGE: pCol = &SwViewOption::GetDocBoundariesColor(); break;
|
|
case SUBCOL_FLY: pCol = &SwViewOption::GetObjectBoundariesColor(); break;
|
|
case SUBCOL_TAB: pCol = &SwViewOption::GetTableBoundariesColor(); break;
|
|
case SUBCOL_SECT: pCol = &SwViewOption::GetSectionBoundColor(); break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( pOut->GetFillColor() != *pCol )
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor( *pCol );
|
|
pOut->DrawRect( rLRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
rLRect.SetPainted();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//-------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
//Diverse Functions die in diesem File so verwendet werden.
|
|
|
|
// Note: function <SwAlignRect(..)> also used outside this file.
|
|
// Correction: adjust rectangle on pixel level in order
|
|
// to assure, that the border 'leaves its original pixel', if it has to.
|
|
// No prior adjustments for odd relation between pixel and twip.
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL SwAlignRect( SwRect &rRect, const ViewShell *pSh )
|
|
{
|
|
if( !rRect.HasArea() )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// Assure that view shell (parameter <pSh>) exists, if the output device
|
|
// is taken from this view shell --> no output device, no alignment.
|
|
// Output device taken from view shell <pSh>, if <bFlyMetafile> not set.
|
|
if ( !bFlyMetafile && !pSh )
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const OutputDevice *pOut = bFlyMetafile ?
|
|
pFlyMetafileOut : pSh->GetOut();
|
|
|
|
// Hold original rectangle in pixel
|
|
const Rectangle aOrgPxRect = pOut->LogicToPixel( rRect.SVRect() );
|
|
// Determine pixel-center rectangle in twip
|
|
const SwRect aPxCenterRect( pOut->PixelToLogic( aOrgPxRect ) );
|
|
|
|
// Perform adjustments on pixel level.
|
|
SwRect aAlignedPxRect( aOrgPxRect );
|
|
if ( rRect.Top() > aPxCenterRect.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
// 'leave pixel overlapping on top'
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Top( aAlignedPxRect.Top() + 1 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rRect.Bottom() < aPxCenterRect.Bottom() )
|
|
{
|
|
// 'leave pixel overlapping on bottom'
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Bottom( aAlignedPxRect.Bottom() - 1 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rRect.Left() > aPxCenterRect.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
// 'leave pixel overlapping on left'
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Left( aAlignedPxRect.Left() + 1 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rRect.Right() < aPxCenterRect.Right() )
|
|
{
|
|
// 'leave pixel overlapping on right'
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Right( aAlignedPxRect.Right() - 1 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Consider negative width/height check, if aligned SwRect has negative width/height.
|
|
// If Yes, adjust it to width/height = 0 twip.
|
|
// NOTE: A SwRect with negative width/height can occur, if the width/height
|
|
// of the given SwRect in twip was less than a pixel in twip and that
|
|
// the alignment calculates that the aligned SwRect should not contain
|
|
// the pixels the width/height is on.
|
|
if ( aAlignedPxRect.Width() < 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Width(0);
|
|
}
|
|
if ( aAlignedPxRect.Height() < 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Height(0);
|
|
}
|
|
// Consider zero width/height for converting a rectangle from
|
|
// pixel to logic it needs a width/height. Thus, set width/height
|
|
// to one, if it's zero and correct this on the twip level after the conversion.
|
|
sal_Bool bZeroWidth = sal_False;
|
|
if ( aAlignedPxRect.Width() == 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Width(1);
|
|
bZeroWidth = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
sal_Bool bZeroHeight = sal_False;
|
|
if ( aAlignedPxRect.Height() == 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
aAlignedPxRect.Height(1);
|
|
bZeroHeight = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
rRect = pOut->PixelToLogic( aAlignedPxRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
// Consider zero width/height and adjust calculated aligned twip rectangle.
|
|
// Reset width/height to zero; previous negative width/height haven't to be considered.
|
|
if ( bZeroWidth )
|
|
{
|
|
rRect.Width(0);
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bZeroHeight )
|
|
{
|
|
rRect.Height(0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** Helper method for twip adjustments on pixel base
|
|
|
|
method compares the x- or y-pixel position of two twip-point. If the x-/y-pixel
|
|
positions are the same, the x-/y-pixel position of the second twip point is
|
|
adjusted by a given amount of pixels.
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
void lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( const OutputDevice& _rOut,
|
|
const Point& _rRefPt,
|
|
Point& _rCompPt,
|
|
const sal_Bool _bChkXPos,
|
|
const sal_Int8 _nPxAdjustment )
|
|
{
|
|
const Point aRefPxPt = _rOut.LogicToPixel( _rRefPt );
|
|
Point aCompPxPt = _rOut.LogicToPixel( _rCompPt );
|
|
|
|
if ( _bChkXPos )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aCompPxPt.X() == aRefPxPt.X() )
|
|
{
|
|
aCompPxPt.X() += _nPxAdjustment ;
|
|
const Point aAdjustedCompPt = _rOut.PixelToLogic( aCompPxPt );
|
|
_rCompPt.X() = aAdjustedCompPt.X();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aCompPxPt.Y() == aRefPxPt.Y() )
|
|
{
|
|
aCompPxPt.Y() += _nPxAdjustment ;
|
|
const Point aAdjustedCompPt = _rOut.PixelToLogic( aCompPxPt );
|
|
_rCompPt.Y() = aAdjustedCompPt.Y();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** Method to pixel-align rectangle for drawing graphic object
|
|
|
|
Because for drawing a graphic left-top-corner and size coordinations are
|
|
used, these coordinations have to be determined on pixel level.
|
|
Thus, convert rectangle to pixel and then convert left-top-corner and
|
|
size of pixel rectangle back to logic.
|
|
This calculation is necessary, because there exists a different between
|
|
the convert from logic to pixel of a normal rectangle with its left-top-
|
|
and right-bottom-corner and the same convert of the same rectangle
|
|
with left-top-corner and size.
|
|
Call this method before each <GraphicObject.Draw(...)>
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
void SwAlignGrfRect( SwRect *pGrfRect, const OutputDevice &rOut )
|
|
{
|
|
Rectangle aPxRect = rOut.LogicToPixel( pGrfRect->SVRect() );
|
|
pGrfRect->Pos( rOut.PixelToLogic( aPxRect.TopLeft() ) );
|
|
pGrfRect->SSize( rOut.PixelToLogic( aPxRect.GetSize() ) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long MA_FASTCALL lcl_AlignWidth( const long nWidth )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( nWidth )
|
|
{
|
|
const long nW = nWidth % nPixelSzW;
|
|
|
|
if ( !nW || nW > nHalfPixelSzW )
|
|
return Max(1L, nWidth - nHalfPixelSzW);
|
|
}
|
|
return nWidth;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long MA_FASTCALL lcl_AlignHeight( const long nHeight )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( nHeight )
|
|
{
|
|
const long nH = nHeight % nPixelSzH;
|
|
|
|
if ( !nH || nH > nHalfPixelSzH )
|
|
return Max(1L, nHeight - nHalfPixelSzH);
|
|
}
|
|
return nHeight;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long MA_FASTCALL lcl_MinHeightDist( const long nDist )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aScaleX < aMinDistScale || aScaleY < aMinDistScale )
|
|
return nDist;
|
|
return ::lcl_AlignHeight( Max( nDist, nMinDistPixelH ));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long MA_FASTCALL lcl_MinWidthDist( const long nDist )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aScaleX < aMinDistScale || aScaleY < aMinDistScale )
|
|
return nDist;
|
|
return ::lcl_AlignWidth( Max( nDist, nMinDistPixelW ));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//Ermittelt PrtArea plus Umrandung plus Schatten.
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_CalcBorderRect( SwRect &rRect, const SwFrm *pFrm,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs,
|
|
const sal_Bool bShadow )
|
|
{
|
|
// Special handling for cell frames.
|
|
// The printing area of a cell frame is completely enclosed in the frame area
|
|
// and a cell frame has no shadow. Thus, for cell frames the calculated
|
|
// area equals the frame area.
|
|
// Notes: Borders of cell frames in R2L text direction will switch its side
|
|
// - left border is painted on the right; right border on the left.
|
|
// See <lcl_PaintLeftLine> and <lcl_PaintRightLine>.
|
|
if( pFrm->IsSctFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
rRect = pFrm->Prt();
|
|
rRect.Pos() += pFrm->Frm().Pos();
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( pFrm->IsCellFrm() )
|
|
rRect = pFrm->Frm();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
rRect = pFrm->Prt();
|
|
rRect.Pos() += pFrm->Frm().Pos();
|
|
|
|
if ( rAttrs.IsLine() || rAttrs.IsBorderDist() ||
|
|
(bShadow && rAttrs.GetShadow().GetLocation() != SVX_SHADOW_NONE) )
|
|
{
|
|
//Badaa: 2008-04-18 * Support for Classical Mongolian Script (SCMS) joint with Jiayanmin
|
|
SwRectFn fnRect = pFrm->IsVertical() ? ( pFrm->IsVertLR() ? fnRectVertL2R : fnRectVert ) : fnRectHori;
|
|
|
|
const SvxBoxItem &rBox = rAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
const sal_Bool bTop = 0 != (pFrm->*fnRect->fnGetTopMargin)();
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nDiff = rBox.GetTop() ?
|
|
rBox.CalcLineSpace( BOX_LINE_TOP ) :
|
|
( rAttrs.IsBorderDist() ?
|
|
// Increase of distance by one twip is incorrect.
|
|
rBox.GetDistance( BOX_LINE_TOP ) : 0 );
|
|
if( nDiff )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnSubTop)( nDiff );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bBottom = 0 != (pFrm->*fnRect->fnGetBottomMargin)();
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nDiff = 0;
|
|
// #i29550#
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsTabFrm() &&
|
|
((SwTabFrm*)pFrm)->IsCollapsingBorders() )
|
|
{
|
|
// For collapsing borders, we have to add the height of
|
|
// the height of the last line
|
|
nDiff = ((SwTabFrm*)pFrm)->GetBottomLineSize();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nDiff = rBox.GetBottom() ?
|
|
rBox.CalcLineSpace( BOX_LINE_BOTTOM ) :
|
|
( rAttrs.IsBorderDist() ?
|
|
// Increase of distance by one twip is incorrect.
|
|
rBox.GetDistance( BOX_LINE_BOTTOM ) : 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
if( nDiff )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnAddBottom)( nDiff );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rBox.GetLeft() )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnSubLeft)( rBox.CalcLineSpace( BOX_LINE_LEFT ) );
|
|
else if ( rAttrs.IsBorderDist() )
|
|
// Increase of distance by one twip is incorrect.
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnSubLeft)( rBox.GetDistance( BOX_LINE_LEFT ) );
|
|
|
|
if ( rBox.GetRight() )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnAddRight)( rBox.CalcLineSpace( BOX_LINE_RIGHT ) );
|
|
else if ( rAttrs.IsBorderDist() )
|
|
// Increase of distance by one twip is incorrect.
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnAddRight)( rBox.GetDistance( BOX_LINE_RIGHT ) );
|
|
|
|
if ( bShadow && rAttrs.GetShadow().GetLocation() != SVX_SHADOW_NONE )
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxShadowItem &rShadow = rAttrs.GetShadow();
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnSubTop)(rShadow.CalcShadowSpace(SHADOW_TOP));
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnSubLeft)(rShadow.CalcShadowSpace(SHADOW_LEFT));
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnAddBottom)
|
|
(rShadow.CalcShadowSpace( SHADOW_BOTTOM ));
|
|
(rRect.*fnRect->fnAddRight)(rShadow.CalcShadowSpace(SHADOW_RIGHT));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
::SwAlignRect( rRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( SwRect& _rRect,
|
|
const SwFrm& _rFrm,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& _rAttrs,
|
|
const SwRectFn& _rRectFn )
|
|
{
|
|
// Extend left/right border/shadow rectangle to bottom of previous frame/to
|
|
// top of next frame, if border/shadow is joined with previous/next frame.
|
|
if ( _rAttrs.JoinedWithPrev( _rFrm ) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pPrevFrm = _rFrm.GetPrev();
|
|
(_rRect.*_rRectFn->fnSetTop)( (pPrevFrm->*_rRectFn->fnGetPrtBottom)() );
|
|
}
|
|
if ( _rAttrs.JoinedWithNext( _rFrm ) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pNextFrm = _rFrm.GetNext();
|
|
(_rRect.*_rRectFn->fnSetBottom)( (pNextFrm->*_rRectFn->fnGetPrtTop)() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_SubtractFlys( const SwFrm *pFrm, const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwRect &rRect, SwRegionRects &rRegion )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwSortedObjs& rObjs = *pPage->GetSortedObjs();
|
|
const SwFlyFrm* pSelfFly = pFrm->IsInFly() ? pFrm->FindFlyFrm() : pRetoucheFly2;
|
|
if ( !pRetoucheFly )
|
|
pRetoucheFly = pRetoucheFly2;
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 j = 0; (j < rObjs.Count()) && rRegion.Count(); ++j )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwAnchoredObject* pAnchoredObj = rObjs[j];
|
|
const SdrObject* pSdrObj = pAnchoredObj->GetDrawObj();
|
|
|
|
// Do not consider invisible objects
|
|
if ( !pPage->GetFmt()->GetDoc()->IsVisibleLayerId( pSdrObj->GetLayer() ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( !pAnchoredObj->ISA(SwFlyFrm) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pFly = static_cast<const SwFlyFrm*>(pAnchoredObj);
|
|
|
|
if ( pSelfFly == pFly || pRetoucheFly == pFly || !rRect.IsOver( pFly->Frm() ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
if ( !pFly->GetFmt()->GetPrint().GetValue() &&
|
|
(OUTDEV_PRINTER == pGlobalShell->GetOut()->GetOutDevType() ||
|
|
pGlobalShell->IsPreView()))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bLowerOfSelf = pSelfFly && pFly->IsLowerOf( pSelfFly ) ?
|
|
sal_True : sal_False;
|
|
|
|
//Bei zeichengebundenem Fly nur diejenigen betrachten, in denen er
|
|
//nicht selbst verankert ist.
|
|
//Warum nur bei zeichengebundenen? Es macht doch nie Sinn
|
|
//Rahmen abzuziehen in denen er selbst verankert ist oder?
|
|
if ( pSelfFly && pSelfFly->IsLowerOf( pFly ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
//Und warum gilt das nicht analog fuer den RetoucheFly?
|
|
if ( pRetoucheFly && pRetoucheFly->IsLowerOf( pFly ) )
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
#if OSL_DEBUG_LEVEL > 1
|
|
//Flys, die innerhalb des eigenen verankert sind, muessen eine
|
|
//groessere OrdNum haben oder Zeichengebunden sein.
|
|
if ( pSelfFly && bLowerOfSelf )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( pFly->IsFlyInCntFrm() ||
|
|
pSdrObj->GetOrdNumDirect() > pSelfFly->GetVirtDrawObj()->GetOrdNumDirect(),
|
|
"Fly with wrong z-Order" );
|
|
}
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bStopOnHell = sal_True;
|
|
if ( pSelfFly )
|
|
{
|
|
const SdrObject *pTmp = pSelfFly->GetVirtDrawObj();
|
|
if ( pSdrObj->GetLayer() == pTmp->GetLayer() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pSdrObj->GetOrdNumDirect() < pTmp->GetOrdNumDirect() )
|
|
//Im gleichen Layer werden nur obenliegende beachtet.
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !bLowerOfSelf && !pFly->GetFmt()->GetOpaque().GetValue() )
|
|
//Aus anderem Layer interessieren uns nur nicht transparente
|
|
//oder innenliegende
|
|
continue;
|
|
bStopOnHell = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pRetoucheFly )
|
|
{
|
|
const SdrObject *pTmp = pRetoucheFly->GetVirtDrawObj();
|
|
if ( pSdrObj->GetLayer() == pTmp->GetLayer() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pSdrObj->GetOrdNumDirect() < pTmp->GetOrdNumDirect() )
|
|
//Im gleichen Layer werden nur obenliegende beachtet.
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pFly->IsLowerOf( pRetoucheFly ) && !pFly->GetFmt()->GetOpaque().GetValue() )
|
|
//Aus anderem Layer interessieren uns nur nicht transparente
|
|
//oder innenliegende
|
|
continue;
|
|
bStopOnHell = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//Wenn der Inhalt des Fly Transparent ist, wird er nicht abgezogen, es sei denn
|
|
//er steht im Hell-Layer
|
|
const IDocumentDrawModelAccess* pIDDMA = pFly->GetFmt()->getIDocumentDrawModelAccess();
|
|
sal_Bool bHell = pSdrObj->GetLayer() == pIDDMA->GetHellId();
|
|
if ( (bStopOnHell && bHell) ||
|
|
/// Change internal order of condition
|
|
/// first check "!bHell", then "..->Lower()" and "..->IsNoTxtFrm()"
|
|
/// have not to be performed, if frame is in "Hell"
|
|
( !bHell && pFly->Lower() && pFly->Lower()->IsNoTxtFrm() &&
|
|
( ((SwNoTxtFrm*)pFly->Lower())->IsTransparent() ||
|
|
((SwNoTxtFrm*)pFly->Lower())->HasAnimation() ||
|
|
pFly->GetFmt()->GetSurround().IsContour()
|
|
)
|
|
)
|
|
)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// Own if-statements for transparent background/shadow of fly frames
|
|
// in order to handle special conditions.
|
|
if ( pFly->IsBackgroundTransparent() )
|
|
{
|
|
// Background <pFly> is transparent drawn. Thus normally, its region
|
|
// have not to be substracted from given region.
|
|
// But, if method is called for a fly frame and
|
|
// <pFly> is a direct lower of this fly frame and
|
|
// <pFly> inherites its transparent background brush from its parent,
|
|
// then <pFly> frame area have to be subtracted from given region.
|
|
// NOTE: Because in Status Quo transparent backgrounds can only be
|
|
// assigned to fly frames, the handle of this special case
|
|
// avoids drawing of transparent areas more than once, if
|
|
// a fly frame inherites a transparent background from its
|
|
// parent fly frame.
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsFlyFrm() &&
|
|
(pFly->GetAnchorFrm()->FindFlyFrm() == pFrm) &&
|
|
static_cast<const SwFlyFrmFmt*>(pFly->GetFmt())->IsBackgroundBrushInherited()
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect;
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)pFly );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( aRect, pFly, rAttrs, sal_True );
|
|
rRegion -= aRect;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pFly->IsShadowTransparent() )
|
|
{
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bHell && pFly->GetAnchorFrm()->IsInFly() )
|
|
{
|
|
//Damit die Umrandung nicht vom Hintergrund des anderen Flys
|
|
//zerlegt wird.
|
|
SwRect aRect;
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)pFly );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( aRect, pFly, rAttrs, sal_True );
|
|
rRegion -= aRect;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect( pFly->Prt() );
|
|
aRect += pFly->Frm().Pos();
|
|
rRegion -= aRect;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pRetoucheFly == pRetoucheFly2 )
|
|
pRetoucheFly = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//---------------- Ausgabe fuer das BrushItem ----------------
|
|
|
|
/** lcl_DrawGraphicBackgrd - local help method to draw a background for a graphic
|
|
|
|
Under certain circumstances we have to draw a background for a graphic.
|
|
This method takes care of the conditions and draws the background with the
|
|
corresponding color.
|
|
Method introduced for bug fix #103876# in order to optimize drawing tiled
|
|
background graphics. Previously, this code was integrated in method
|
|
<lcl_DrawGraphic>.
|
|
Method implemented as a inline, checking the conditions and calling method
|
|
method <lcl_implDrawGraphicBackgrd(..)> for the intrinsic drawing.
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@param _rBackgrdBrush
|
|
background brush contain the color the background has to be drawn.
|
|
|
|
@param _pOut
|
|
output device the background has to be drawn in.
|
|
|
|
@param _rPaintRect
|
|
paint retangle in the output device, which has to be drawn with the background.
|
|
rectangle have to be aligned by method ::SwAlignRect
|
|
|
|
@param _rGraphicObj
|
|
graphic object, for which the background has to be drawn. Used for checking
|
|
the transparency of its bitmap, its type and if the graphic is drawn transparent
|
|
|
|
@param _bNumberingGraphic
|
|
boolean indicating that graphic is used as a numbering.
|
|
|
|
@param _bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn
|
|
boolean (optional; default: false) indicating, if the background is already drawn.
|
|
*/
|
|
void lcl_implDrawGraphicBackgrd( const SvxBrushItem& _rBackgrdBrush,
|
|
OutputDevice* _pOut,
|
|
const SwRect& _rAlignedPaintRect,
|
|
const GraphicObject& _rGraphicObj )
|
|
{
|
|
/// determine color of background
|
|
/// If color of background brush is not "no fill"/"auto fill" or
|
|
/// <bFlyMetafile> is set, use color of background brush, otherwise
|
|
/// use global retouche color.
|
|
const Color aColor( ( (_rBackgrdBrush.GetColor() != COL_TRANSPARENT) || bFlyMetafile )
|
|
? _rBackgrdBrush.GetColor()
|
|
: aGlobalRetoucheColor );
|
|
|
|
/// determine, if background color have to be drawn transparent
|
|
/// and calculate transparency percent value
|
|
sal_Int8 nTransparencyPercent = 0;
|
|
bool bDrawTransparent = false;
|
|
if ( aColor.GetTransparency() != 0 )
|
|
/// background color is transparent --> draw transparent.
|
|
{
|
|
bDrawTransparent = true;
|
|
nTransparencyPercent = (aColor.GetTransparency()*100 + 0x7F)/0xFF;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( (_rGraphicObj.GetAttr().GetTransparency() != 0) &&
|
|
(_rBackgrdBrush.GetColor() == COL_TRANSPARENT) )
|
|
/// graphic is drawn transparent and background color is
|
|
/// "no fill"/"auto fill" --> draw transparent
|
|
{
|
|
bDrawTransparent = true;
|
|
nTransparencyPercent = (_rGraphicObj.GetAttr().GetTransparency()*100 + 0x7F)/0xFF;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bDrawTransparent )
|
|
{
|
|
/// draw background transparent
|
|
if( _pOut->GetFillColor() != aColor.GetRGBColor() )
|
|
_pOut->SetFillColor( aColor.GetRGBColor() );
|
|
PolyPolygon aPoly( _rAlignedPaintRect.SVRect() );
|
|
_pOut->DrawTransparent( aPoly, nTransparencyPercent );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
/// draw background opaque
|
|
if ( _pOut->GetFillColor() != aColor )
|
|
_pOut->SetFillColor( aColor );
|
|
_pOut->DrawRect( _rAlignedPaintRect.SVRect() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
inline void lcl_DrawGraphicBackgrd( const SvxBrushItem& _rBackgrdBrush,
|
|
OutputDevice* _pOut,
|
|
const SwRect& _rAlignedPaintRect,
|
|
const GraphicObject& _rGraphicObj,
|
|
bool _bNumberingGraphic,
|
|
bool _bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn = false )
|
|
{
|
|
/// draw background with background color, if
|
|
/// (1) graphic is not used as a numbering AND
|
|
/// (2) background is not already drawn AND
|
|
/// (3) intrinsic graphic is transparent OR intrinsic graphic doesn't exists
|
|
if ( !_bNumberingGraphic &&
|
|
!_bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn &&
|
|
( _rGraphicObj.IsTransparent() || _rGraphicObj.GetType() == GRAPHIC_NONE )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
lcl_implDrawGraphicBackgrd( _rBackgrdBrush, _pOut, _rAlignedPaintRect, _rGraphicObj );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// Note: the transparency of the background graphic
|
|
/// is saved in SvxBrushItem.GetGraphicObject(<shell>).GetAttr().Set/GetTransparency()
|
|
/// and is considered in the drawing of the graphic.
|
|
/// Thus, to provide transparent background graphic for text frames nothing
|
|
/// has to be coded.
|
|
/// Use align rectangle for drawing graphic
|
|
/// Pixel-align coordinations for drawing graphic.
|
|
/// Outsource code for drawing background of the graphic
|
|
/// with a background color in method <lcl_DrawGraphicBackgrd>
|
|
/// Also, change type of <bGrfNum> and <bClip> from <sal_Bool> to <bool>.
|
|
void lcl_DrawGraphic( const SvxBrushItem& rBrush, OutputDevice *pOut,
|
|
ViewShell &rSh, const SwRect &rGrf, const SwRect &rOut,
|
|
bool bClip, bool bGrfNum,
|
|
bool bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn = false )
|
|
/// add parameter <bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn> to indicate
|
|
/// that the background is already drawn.
|
|
{
|
|
/// Calculate align rectangle from parameter <rGrf> and use aligned
|
|
/// rectangle <aAlignedGrfRect> in the following code
|
|
SwRect aAlignedGrfRect = rGrf;
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aAlignedGrfRect, &rSh );
|
|
|
|
/// Change type from <sal_Bool> to <bool>.
|
|
const bool bNotInside = bClip && !rOut.IsInside( aAlignedGrfRect );
|
|
if ( bNotInside )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_CLIPREGION );
|
|
pOut->IntersectClipRegion( rOut.SVRect() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//Hier kein Link, wir wollen die Grafik synchron laden!
|
|
((SvxBrushItem&)rBrush).SetDoneLink( Link() );
|
|
GraphicObject *pGrf = (GraphicObject*)rBrush.GetGraphicObject();
|
|
|
|
/// Outsourcing drawing of background with a background color.
|
|
::lcl_DrawGraphicBackgrd( rBrush, pOut, aAlignedGrfRect, *pGrf, bGrfNum, bBackgrdAlreadyDrawn );
|
|
|
|
/// Because for drawing a graphic left-top-corner and size coordinations are
|
|
/// used, these coordinations have to be determined on pixel level.
|
|
::SwAlignGrfRect( &aAlignedGrfRect, *pOut );
|
|
pGrf->DrawWithPDFHandling( *pOut, aAlignedGrfRect.Pos(), aAlignedGrfRect.SSize() );
|
|
|
|
if ( bNotInside )
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
} // end of method <lcl_DrawGraphic>
|
|
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL DrawGraphic( const SvxBrushItem *pBrush,
|
|
OutputDevice *pOutDev,
|
|
const SwRect &rOrg,
|
|
const SwRect &rOut,
|
|
const sal_uInt8 nGrfNum,
|
|
const sal_Bool bConsiderBackgroundTransparency )
|
|
/// Add 6th parameter to indicate that method should
|
|
/// consider background transparency, saved in the color of the brush item
|
|
{
|
|
ViewShell &rSh = *pGlobalShell;
|
|
bool bReplaceGrfNum = GRFNUM_REPLACE == nGrfNum;
|
|
bool bGrfNum = GRFNUM_NO != nGrfNum;
|
|
Size aGrfSize;
|
|
SvxGraphicPosition ePos = GPOS_NONE;
|
|
if( pBrush && !bReplaceGrfNum )
|
|
{
|
|
if( rSh.GetViewOptions()->IsGraphic() )
|
|
{
|
|
// load graphic directly in PDF import
|
|
// #i68953# - also during print load graphic directly.
|
|
if ( (rSh).GetViewOptions()->IsPDFExport() ||
|
|
rSh.GetOut()->GetOutDevType() == OUTDEV_PRINTER )
|
|
{
|
|
((SvxBrushItem*)pBrush)->PurgeMedium();
|
|
((SvxBrushItem*)pBrush)->SetDoneLink( Link() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
((SvxBrushItem*)pBrush)->SetDoneLink( STATIC_LINK(
|
|
rSh.GetDoc(), SwDoc, BackgroundDone ) );
|
|
//SfxObjectShell &rObjSh = *GETOBJSHELL();
|
|
const Graphic* pGrf = pBrush->GetGraphic();
|
|
if( pGrf && GRAPHIC_NONE != pGrf->GetType() )
|
|
{
|
|
ePos = pBrush->GetGraphicPos();
|
|
if( pGrf->IsSupportedGraphic() )
|
|
// don't the use the specific output device! Bug 94802
|
|
aGrfSize = ::GetGraphicSizeTwip( *pGrf, 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bReplaceGrfNum = bGrfNum;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aGrf;
|
|
aGrf.SSize( aGrfSize );
|
|
sal_Bool bDraw = sal_True;
|
|
sal_Bool bRetouche = sal_True;
|
|
switch ( ePos )
|
|
{
|
|
case GPOS_LT:
|
|
aGrf.Pos() = rOrg.Pos();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_MT:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Top();
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Left() + rOrg.Width()/2 - aGrfSize.Width()/2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_RT:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Top();
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Right() - aGrfSize.Width();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_LM:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Top() + rOrg.Height()/2 - aGrfSize.Height()/2;
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Left();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_MM:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Top() + rOrg.Height()/2 - aGrfSize.Height()/2;
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Left() + rOrg.Width()/2 - aGrfSize.Width()/2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_RM:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Top() + rOrg.Height()/2 - aGrfSize.Height()/2;
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Right() - aGrfSize.Width();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_LB:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Bottom() - aGrfSize.Height();
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Left();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_MB:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Bottom() - aGrfSize.Height();
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Left() + rOrg.Width()/2 - aGrfSize.Width()/2;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_RB:
|
|
aGrf.Pos().Y() = rOrg.Bottom() - aGrfSize.Height();
|
|
aGrf.Pos().X() = rOrg.Right() - aGrfSize.Width();
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_AREA:
|
|
aGrf = rOrg;
|
|
/// In spite the fact that the background graphic have to fill the complete
|
|
/// area, it has been checked, if the graphic will completely fill out
|
|
/// the region to be painted <rOut> and thus, nothing has to be retouched.
|
|
/// For example, this is the case for a fly frame without a background
|
|
/// brush positioned on the border of the page and inherited the
|
|
/// background brush from the page.
|
|
bRetouche = !rOut.IsInside( aGrf );
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_TILED:
|
|
{
|
|
// draw background of tiled graphic before drawing tiled graphic in loop
|
|
// determine graphic object
|
|
GraphicObject* pGraphicObj = const_cast< GraphicObject* >(pBrush->GetGraphicObject());
|
|
// calculate aligned paint rectangle
|
|
SwRect aAlignedPaintRect = rOut;
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aAlignedPaintRect, &rSh );
|
|
// draw background color for aligned paint rectangle
|
|
lcl_DrawGraphicBackgrd( *pBrush, pOutDev, aAlignedPaintRect, *pGraphicObj, bGrfNum );
|
|
|
|
// set left-top-corner of background graphic to left-top-corner of the
|
|
// area, from which the background brush is determined.
|
|
aGrf.Pos() = rOrg.Pos();
|
|
// setup clipping at output device
|
|
pOutDev->Push( PUSH_CLIPREGION );
|
|
pOutDev->IntersectClipRegion( rOut.SVRect() );
|
|
// use new method <GraphicObject::DrawTiled(::)>
|
|
{
|
|
// calculate paint offset
|
|
Point aPaintOffset( aAlignedPaintRect.Pos() - aGrf.Pos() );
|
|
// draw background graphic tiled for aligned paint rectangle
|
|
// #i42643#
|
|
// For PDF export, every draw operation for bitmaps takes a
|
|
// noticeable amount of place (~50 characters). Thus, optimize
|
|
// between tile bitmap size and number of drawing operations here.
|
|
//
|
|
// A_out
|
|
// n_chars = k1 * ---------- + k2 * A_bitmap
|
|
// A_bitmap
|
|
//
|
|
// minimum n_chars is obtained for (derive for A_bitmap,
|
|
// set to 0, take positive solution):
|
|
// k1
|
|
// A_bitmap = Sqrt( ---- A_out )
|
|
// k2
|
|
//
|
|
// where k1 is the number of chars per draw operation, and
|
|
// k2 is the number of chars per bitmap pixel.
|
|
// This is approximately 50 and 7 for current PDF writer, respectively.
|
|
//
|
|
const double k1( 50 );
|
|
const double k2( 7 );
|
|
const Size aSize( aAlignedPaintRect.SSize() );
|
|
const double Abitmap( k1/k2 * static_cast<double>(aSize.Width())*aSize.Height() );
|
|
|
|
pGraphicObj->DrawTiled( pOutDev,
|
|
aAlignedPaintRect.SVRect(),
|
|
aGrf.SSize(),
|
|
Size( aPaintOffset.X(), aPaintOffset.Y() ),
|
|
NULL, GRFMGR_DRAW_STANDARD,
|
|
::std::max( 128, static_cast<int>( sqrt(sqrt( Abitmap)) + .5 ) ) );
|
|
}
|
|
// reset clipping at output device
|
|
pOutDev->Pop();
|
|
// set <bDraw> and <bRetouche> to false, indicating that background
|
|
// graphic and background are already drawn.
|
|
bDraw = bRetouche = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case GPOS_NONE:
|
|
bDraw = sal_False;
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
default: OSL_ENSURE( !pOutDev, "new Graphic position?" );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// init variable <bGrfBackgrdAlreadDrawn> to indicate, if background of
|
|
/// graphic is already drawn or not.
|
|
bool bGrfBackgrdAlreadyDrawn = false;
|
|
if ( bRetouche )
|
|
{
|
|
pOutDev->Push( PUSH_FILLCOLOR|PUSH_LINECOLOR );
|
|
pOutDev->SetLineColor();
|
|
|
|
// check, if a existing background graphic (not filling the complete
|
|
// background) is transparent drawn and the background color is
|
|
// "no fill" respectively "auto fill", if background transparency
|
|
// has to be considered.
|
|
// If YES, memorise transparency of background graphic.
|
|
// check also, if background graphic bitmap is transparent.
|
|
bool bTransparentGrfWithNoFillBackgrd = false;
|
|
sal_Int32 nGrfTransparency = 0;
|
|
bool bGrfIsTransparent = false;
|
|
if ( (ePos != GPOS_NONE) &&
|
|
(ePos != GPOS_TILED) && (ePos != GPOS_AREA)
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
GraphicObject *pGrf = (GraphicObject*)pBrush->GetGraphicObject();
|
|
if ( bConsiderBackgroundTransparency )
|
|
{
|
|
GraphicAttr pGrfAttr = pGrf->GetAttr();
|
|
if ( (pGrfAttr.GetTransparency() != 0) &&
|
|
( pBrush && (pBrush->GetColor() == COL_TRANSPARENT) )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
bTransparentGrfWithNoFillBackgrd = true;
|
|
nGrfTransparency = pGrfAttr.GetTransparency();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pGrf->IsTransparent() )
|
|
{
|
|
bGrfIsTransparent = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// to get color of brush, check background color against COL_TRANSPARENT ("no fill"/"auto fill")
|
|
/// instead of checking, if transparency is not set.
|
|
const Color aColor( pBrush &&
|
|
( !(pBrush->GetColor() == COL_TRANSPARENT) ||
|
|
bFlyMetafile )
|
|
? pBrush->GetColor()
|
|
: aGlobalRetoucheColor );
|
|
|
|
/// determine, if background region have to be
|
|
/// drawn transparent.
|
|
/// background region has to be drawn transparent, if
|
|
/// background transparency have to be considered
|
|
/// AND
|
|
/// ( background color is transparent OR
|
|
/// background graphic is transparent and background color is "no fill"
|
|
/// )
|
|
sal_Bool bDrawTransparent = bConsiderBackgroundTransparency &&
|
|
( ( aColor.GetTransparency() != 0) ||
|
|
bTransparentGrfWithNoFillBackgrd );
|
|
|
|
// #i75614# reset draw mode in high contrast mode in order to get fill color set
|
|
const sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = pOutDev->GetDrawMode();
|
|
if ( pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
pOutDev->SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - if background region have to be drawn
|
|
/// transparent, set only the RGB values of the background color as
|
|
/// the fill color for the output device.
|
|
if ( bDrawTransparent )
|
|
{
|
|
if( pOutDev->GetFillColor() != aColor.GetRGBColor() )
|
|
pOutDev->SetFillColor( aColor.GetRGBColor() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if( pOutDev->GetFillColor() != aColor )
|
|
pOutDev->SetFillColor( aColor );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// #i75614#
|
|
// restore draw mode
|
|
pOutDev->SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
|
|
/// OD 02.09.2002 #99657#
|
|
if ( bDrawTransparent )
|
|
{
|
|
/// background region have to be drawn transparent.
|
|
/// Thus, create a poly-polygon from the region and draw it with
|
|
/// the corresponding transparency precent.
|
|
PolyPolygon aDrawPoly( rOut.SVRect() );
|
|
if ( aGrf.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !bGrfIsTransparent )
|
|
{
|
|
/// substract area of background graphic from draw area
|
|
/// OD 08.10.2002 #103898# - consider only that part of the
|
|
/// graphic area that is overlapping with draw area.
|
|
SwRect aTmpGrf = aGrf;
|
|
aTmpGrf.Intersection( rOut );
|
|
if ( aTmpGrf.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
Polygon aGrfPoly( aTmpGrf.SVRect() );
|
|
aDrawPoly.Insert( aGrfPoly );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bGrfBackgrdAlreadyDrawn = true;
|
|
}
|
|
/// calculate transparency percent:
|
|
/// ( <transparency value[0x01..0xFF]>*100 + 0x7F ) / 0xFF
|
|
/// If there is a background graphic with a background color "no fill"/"auto fill",
|
|
/// the transparency value is taken from the background graphic,
|
|
/// otherwise take the transparency value from the color.
|
|
sal_Int8 nTransparencyPercent = static_cast<sal_Int8>(
|
|
(( bTransparentGrfWithNoFillBackgrd ? nGrfTransparency : aColor.GetTransparency()
|
|
)*100 + 0x7F)/0xFF);
|
|
/// draw poly-polygon transparent
|
|
pOutDev->DrawTransparent( aDrawPoly, nTransparencyPercent );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SwRegionRects aRegion( rOut, 4 );
|
|
if ( !bGrfIsTransparent )
|
|
aRegion -= aGrf;
|
|
else
|
|
bGrfBackgrdAlreadyDrawn = true;
|
|
/// loop rectangles of background region, which has to be drawn
|
|
for( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
pOutDev->DrawRect( aRegion[i].SVRect() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
pOutDev ->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if( bDraw && aGrf.IsOver( rOut ) )
|
|
/// OD 02.09.2002 #99657#
|
|
/// add parameter <bGrfBackgrdAlreadyDrawn>
|
|
lcl_DrawGraphic( *pBrush, pOutDev, rSh, aGrf, rOut, true, bGrfNum,
|
|
bGrfBackgrdAlreadyDrawn );
|
|
|
|
if( bReplaceGrfNum )
|
|
{
|
|
const BitmapEx& rBmp = ViewShell::GetReplacementBitmap( false );
|
|
Font aTmp( pOutDev->GetFont() );
|
|
Graphic::DrawEx( pOutDev, aEmptyStr, aTmp, rBmp, rOrg.Pos(), rOrg.SSize() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
/** local help method for SwRootFrm::Paint(..) - Adjust given rectangle to pixel size
|
|
|
|
By OD at 27.09.2002 for #103636#
|
|
In order to avoid paint errors caused by multiple alignments - e.g. method
|
|
::SwAlignRect(..) - and other changes to the rectangle to be painted,
|
|
this method is called for the rectangle to be painted in order to
|
|
adjust it to the pixel it is overlapping.
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
void lcl_AdjustRectToPixelSize( SwRect& io_aSwRect, const OutputDevice &aOut )
|
|
{
|
|
/// local constant object of class <Size> to determine number of Twips
|
|
/// representing a pixel.
|
|
const Size aTwipToPxSize( aOut.PixelToLogic( Size( 1,1 )) );
|
|
|
|
/// local object of class <Rectangle> in Twip coordinates
|
|
/// calculated from given rectangle aligned to pixel centers.
|
|
const Rectangle aPxCenterRect = aOut.PixelToLogic(
|
|
aOut.LogicToPixel( io_aSwRect.SVRect() ) );
|
|
|
|
/// local constant object of class <Rectangle> representing given rectangle
|
|
/// in pixel.
|
|
const Rectangle aOrgPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( io_aSwRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
/// calculate adjusted rectangle from pixel centered rectangle.
|
|
/// Due to rounding differences <aPxCenterRect> doesn't exactly represents
|
|
/// the Twip-centers. Thus, adjust borders by half of pixel width/height plus 1.
|
|
/// Afterwards, adjust calculated Twip-positions of the all borders.
|
|
Rectangle aSizedRect = aPxCenterRect;
|
|
aSizedRect.Left() -= (aTwipToPxSize.Width()/2 + 1);
|
|
aSizedRect.Right() += (aTwipToPxSize.Width()/2 + 1);
|
|
aSizedRect.Top() -= (aTwipToPxSize.Height()/2 + 1);
|
|
aSizedRect.Bottom() += (aTwipToPxSize.Height()/2 + 1);
|
|
|
|
/// adjust left()
|
|
while ( (aOut.LogicToPixel(aSizedRect)).Left() < aOrgPxRect.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
++aSizedRect.Left();
|
|
}
|
|
/// adjust right()
|
|
while ( (aOut.LogicToPixel(aSizedRect)).Right() > aOrgPxRect.Right() )
|
|
{
|
|
--aSizedRect.Right();
|
|
}
|
|
/// adjust top()
|
|
while ( (aOut.LogicToPixel(aSizedRect)).Top() < aOrgPxRect.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
++aSizedRect.Top();
|
|
}
|
|
/// adjust bottom()
|
|
while ( (aOut.LogicToPixel(aSizedRect)).Bottom() > aOrgPxRect.Bottom() )
|
|
{
|
|
--aSizedRect.Bottom();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
io_aSwRect = SwRect( aSizedRect );
|
|
|
|
#if OSL_DEBUG_LEVEL > 1
|
|
Rectangle aTestOrgPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( io_aSwRect.SVRect() );
|
|
Rectangle aTestNewPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( aSizedRect );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aTestOrgPxRect == aTestNewPxRect,
|
|
"Error in lcl_AlignRectToPixelSize(..): Adjusted rectangle has incorrect position or size");
|
|
Rectangle aTestNewRect( aSizedRect );
|
|
/// check Left()
|
|
--aSizedRect.Left();
|
|
aTestNewPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( aSizedRect );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aTestOrgPxRect.Left() >= (aTestNewPxRect.Left()+1),
|
|
"Error in lcl_AlignRectToPixelSize(..): Left() not correct adjusted");
|
|
++aSizedRect.Left();
|
|
/// check Right()
|
|
++aSizedRect.Right();
|
|
aTestNewPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( aSizedRect );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aTestOrgPxRect.Right() <= (aTestNewPxRect.Right()-1),
|
|
"Error in lcl_AlignRectToPixelSize(..): Right() not correct adjusted");
|
|
--aSizedRect.Right();
|
|
/// check Top()
|
|
--aSizedRect.Top();
|
|
aTestNewPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( aSizedRect );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aTestOrgPxRect.Top() >= (aTestNewPxRect.Top()+1),
|
|
"Error in lcl_AlignRectToPixelSize(..): Top() not correct adjusted");
|
|
++aSizedRect.Top();
|
|
/// check Bottom()
|
|
++aSizedRect.Bottom();
|
|
aTestNewPxRect = aOut.LogicToPixel( aSizedRect );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aTestOrgPxRect.Bottom() <= (aTestNewPxRect.Bottom()-1),
|
|
"Error in lcl_AlignRectToPixelSize(..): Bottom() not correct adjusted");
|
|
--aSizedRect.Bottom();
|
|
#endif
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
// FUNCTIONS USED FOR COLLAPSING TABLE BORDER LINES START
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
struct SwLineEntry
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips mnKey;
|
|
SwTwips mnStartPos;
|
|
SwTwips mnEndPos;
|
|
|
|
svx::frame::Style maAttribute;
|
|
|
|
enum OverlapType { NO_OVERLAP, OVERLAP1, OVERLAP2, OVERLAP3 };
|
|
|
|
public:
|
|
SwLineEntry( SwTwips nKey,
|
|
SwTwips nStartPos,
|
|
SwTwips nEndPos,
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rAttribute );
|
|
|
|
OverlapType Overlaps( const SwLineEntry& rComp ) const;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntry::SwLineEntry( SwTwips nKey,
|
|
SwTwips nStartPos,
|
|
SwTwips nEndPos,
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rAttribute )
|
|
: mnKey( nKey ),
|
|
mnStartPos( nStartPos ),
|
|
mnEndPos( nEndPos ),
|
|
maAttribute( rAttribute )
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
1. ---------- rOld
|
|
---------- rNew
|
|
|
|
2. ---------- rOld
|
|
------------- rNew
|
|
|
|
3. ------- rOld
|
|
------------- rNew
|
|
|
|
4. ------------- rOld
|
|
---------- rNew
|
|
|
|
5. ---------- rOld
|
|
---- rNew
|
|
|
|
6. ---------- rOld
|
|
---------- rNew
|
|
|
|
7. ------------- rOld
|
|
---------- rNew
|
|
|
|
8. ---------- rOld
|
|
------------- rNew
|
|
|
|
9. ---------- rOld
|
|
---------- rNew
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntry::OverlapType SwLineEntry::Overlaps( const SwLineEntry& rNew ) const
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineEntry::OverlapType eRet = OVERLAP3;
|
|
|
|
if ( mnStartPos >= rNew.mnEndPos || mnEndPos <= rNew.mnStartPos )
|
|
eRet = NO_OVERLAP;
|
|
|
|
// 1, 2, 3
|
|
else if ( mnEndPos < rNew.mnEndPos )
|
|
eRet = OVERLAP1;
|
|
|
|
// 4, 5, 6, 7
|
|
else if ( mnStartPos <= rNew.mnStartPos && mnEndPos >= rNew.mnEndPos )
|
|
eRet = OVERLAP2;
|
|
|
|
// 8, 9
|
|
return eRet;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
struct lt_SwLineEntry
|
|
{
|
|
bool operator()( const SwLineEntry& e1, const SwLineEntry& e2 ) const
|
|
{
|
|
return e1.mnStartPos < e2.mnStartPos;
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
typedef std::set< SwLineEntry, lt_SwLineEntry > SwLineEntrySet;
|
|
typedef std::set< SwLineEntry, lt_SwLineEntry >::iterator SwLineEntrySetIter;
|
|
typedef std::set< SwLineEntry, lt_SwLineEntry >::const_iterator SwLineEntrySetConstIter;
|
|
typedef std::map< SwTwips, SwLineEntrySet > SwLineEntryMap;
|
|
typedef std::map< SwTwips, SwLineEntrySet >::iterator SwLineEntryMapIter;
|
|
typedef std::map< SwTwips, SwLineEntrySet >::const_iterator SwLineEntryMapConstIter;
|
|
|
|
class SwTabFrmPainter
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineEntryMap maVertLines;
|
|
SwLineEntryMap maHoriLines;
|
|
const SwTabFrm& mrTabFrm;
|
|
|
|
void Insert( SwLineEntry&, bool bHori );
|
|
void Insert( const SwFrm& rFrm, const SvxBoxItem& rBoxItem );
|
|
void HandleFrame( const SwLayoutFrm& rFrm );
|
|
void FindStylesForLine( const Point&,
|
|
const Point&,
|
|
svx::frame::Style*,
|
|
bool bHori ) const;
|
|
|
|
public:
|
|
SwTabFrmPainter( const SwTabFrm& rTabFrm );
|
|
|
|
void PaintLines( OutputDevice& rDev, const SwRect& rRect ) const;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
SwTabFrmPainter::SwTabFrmPainter( const SwTabFrm& rTabFrm )
|
|
: mrTabFrm( rTabFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
HandleFrame( rTabFrm );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwTabFrmPainter::HandleFrame( const SwLayoutFrm& rLayoutFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
// Add border lines of cell frames. Skip covered cells. Skip cells
|
|
// in special row span row, which do not have a negative row span:
|
|
if ( rLayoutFrm.IsCellFrm() && !rLayoutFrm.IsCoveredCell() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwCellFrm* pThisCell = static_cast<const SwCellFrm*>(&rLayoutFrm);
|
|
const SwRowFrm* pRowFrm = static_cast<const SwRowFrm*>(pThisCell->GetUpper());
|
|
const long nRowSpan = pThisCell->GetTabBox()->getRowSpan();
|
|
if ( !pRowFrm->IsRowSpanLine() || nRowSpan > 1 || nRowSpan < -1 )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), &rLayoutFrm );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& rBox = rAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
Insert( rLayoutFrm, rBox );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Recurse into lower layout frames, but do not recurse into lower tabframes.
|
|
const SwFrm* pLower = rLayoutFrm.Lower();
|
|
while ( pLower )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLayoutFrm* pLowerLayFrm = dynamic_cast<const SwLayoutFrm*>(pLower);
|
|
if ( pLowerLayFrm && !pLowerLayFrm->IsTabFrm() )
|
|
HandleFrame( *pLowerLayFrm );
|
|
|
|
pLower = pLower->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwTabFrmPainter::PaintLines( OutputDevice& rDev, const SwRect& rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, rDev );
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm* pTmpFrm = &mrTabFrm;
|
|
const bool bVert = pTmpFrm->IsVertical();
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntryMapConstIter aIter = maHoriLines.begin();
|
|
bool bHori = true;
|
|
|
|
// color for subsidiary lines:
|
|
const Color& rCol( SwViewOption::GetTableBoundariesColor() );
|
|
|
|
// high contrast mode:
|
|
// overrides the color of non-subsidiary lines.
|
|
const Color* pHCColor = 0;
|
|
sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = rDev.GetDrawMode();
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
pHCColor = &SwViewOption::GetFontColor();
|
|
rDev.SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// set clip region:
|
|
rDev.Push( PUSH_CLIPREGION );
|
|
Size aSize( rRect.SSize() );
|
|
// Hack! Necessary, because the layout is not pixel aligned!
|
|
aSize.Width() += nPixelSzW; aSize.Height() += nPixelSzH;
|
|
rDev.SetClipRegion( Rectangle( rRect.Pos(), aSize ) );
|
|
|
|
// The following stuff if necessary to have the new table borders fit
|
|
// into a ::SwAlignRect adjusted world.
|
|
const SwTwips nTwipXCorr = bVert ? 0 : Max( 0L, nHalfPixelSzW - 2 ); // 1 < 2 < 3 ;-)
|
|
const SwTwips nTwipYCorr = !bVert ? 0 : Max( 0L, nHalfPixelSzW - 2 ); // 1 < 2 < 3 ;-)
|
|
const SwFrm* pUpper = mrTabFrm.GetUpper();
|
|
SwRect aUpper( pUpper->Prt() );
|
|
aUpper.Pos() += pUpper->Frm().Pos();
|
|
SwRect aUpperAligned( aUpper );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aUpperAligned, pGlobalShell );
|
|
|
|
while ( true )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bHori && aIter == maHoriLines.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
aIter = maVertLines.begin();
|
|
bHori = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !bHori && aIter == maVertLines.end() )
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
const SwLineEntrySet& rEntrySet = (*aIter).second;
|
|
SwLineEntrySetConstIter aSetIter = rEntrySet.begin();
|
|
while ( aSetIter != rEntrySet.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rEntry = *aSetIter;
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rEntryStyle( (*aSetIter).maAttribute );
|
|
|
|
Point aStart, aEnd;
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
aStart.X() = rEntry.mnStartPos;
|
|
aStart.Y() = rEntry.mnKey;
|
|
aEnd.X() = rEntry.mnEndPos;
|
|
aEnd.Y() = rEntry.mnKey;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aStart.X() = rEntry.mnKey;
|
|
aStart.Y() = rEntry.mnStartPos;
|
|
aEnd.X() = rEntry.mnKey;
|
|
aEnd.Y() = rEntry.mnEndPos;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRepaintRect( aStart, aEnd );
|
|
|
|
// the repaint rectangle has to be moved a bit for the centered lines:
|
|
SwTwips nRepaintRectSize = !rEntryStyle.GetWidth() ? 1 : rEntryStyle.GetWidth();
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
aRepaintRect.Height( 2 * nRepaintRectSize );
|
|
aRepaintRect.Pos().Y() -= nRepaintRectSize;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aRepaintRect.Width( 2 * nRepaintRectSize );
|
|
aRepaintRect.Pos().X() -= nRepaintRectSize;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rRect.IsOver( aRepaintRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
svx::frame::Style aStyles[ 7 ];
|
|
aStyles[ 0 ] = rEntryStyle;
|
|
FindStylesForLine( aStart, aEnd, aStyles, bHori );
|
|
|
|
// subsidiary lines
|
|
const Color* pTmpColor = 0;
|
|
if ( 0 == aStyles[ 0 ].GetWidth() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( IS_SUBS_TABLE && pGlobalShell->GetWin() )
|
|
aStyles[ 0 ].Set( rCol, rCol, rCol, false, 1, 0, 0 );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
pTmpColor = pHCColor;
|
|
|
|
// The line sizes stored in the line style have to be adjusted as well.
|
|
// This will guarantee that lines with the same twip size will have the
|
|
// same pixel size.
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < 7; ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
sal_uInt16 nPrim = aStyles[ i ].Prim();
|
|
sal_uInt16 nDist = aStyles[ i ].Dist();
|
|
sal_uInt16 nSecn = aStyles[ i ].Secn();
|
|
|
|
if ( nPrim > 0 )
|
|
nPrim = (sal_uInt16)( Max( 1L, nPixelSzH * ( nPrim / nPixelSzH ) ) );
|
|
if ( nDist > 0 )
|
|
nDist = (sal_uInt16)( Max( 1L, nPixelSzH * ( nDist / nPixelSzH ) ) );
|
|
if ( nSecn > 0 )
|
|
nSecn = (sal_uInt16)( Max( 1L, nPixelSzH * ( nSecn / nPixelSzH ) ) );
|
|
|
|
aStyles[ i ].Set( nPrim, nDist, nSecn );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The (twip) positions will be adjusted to meet these requirements:
|
|
// 1. The y coordinates are located in the middle of the pixel grid
|
|
// 2. The x coordinated are located at the beginning of the pixel grid
|
|
// This is done, because the horizontal lines are painted "at beginning",
|
|
// whereas the vertical lines are painted "centered". By making the line
|
|
// sizes a multiple of one pixel size, we can assure, that all lines having
|
|
// the same twip size have the same pixel size, independent of their position
|
|
// on the screen.
|
|
Point aPaintStart = rDev.PixelToLogic( rDev.LogicToPixel( aStart ) );
|
|
Point aPaintEnd = rDev.PixelToLogic( rDev.LogicToPixel( aEnd ) );
|
|
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
// The table borders do not use SwAlignRect, but all the other frames do.
|
|
// Therefore we tweak the outer borders a bit to achieve that the outer
|
|
// borders match the subsidiary lines of the upper:
|
|
if ( aStart.X() == aUpper.Left() )
|
|
aPaintStart.X() = aUpperAligned.Left();
|
|
else if ( aStart.X() == aUpper._Right() )
|
|
aPaintStart.X() = aUpperAligned._Right();
|
|
if ( aStart.Y() == aUpper.Top() )
|
|
aPaintStart.Y() = aUpperAligned.Top();
|
|
else if ( aStart.Y() == aUpper._Bottom() )
|
|
aPaintStart.Y() = aUpperAligned._Bottom();
|
|
|
|
if ( aEnd.X() == aUpper.Left() )
|
|
aPaintEnd.X() = aUpperAligned.Left();
|
|
else if ( aEnd.X() == aUpper._Right() )
|
|
aPaintEnd.X() = aUpperAligned._Right();
|
|
if ( aEnd.Y() == aUpper.Top() )
|
|
aPaintEnd.Y() = aUpperAligned.Top();
|
|
else if ( aEnd.Y() == aUpper._Bottom() )
|
|
aPaintEnd.Y() = aUpperAligned._Bottom();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
aPaintStart.X() -= nTwipXCorr; // nHalfPixelSzW - 2 to assure that we do not leave the pixel
|
|
aPaintEnd.X() -= nTwipXCorr;
|
|
aPaintStart.Y() -= nTwipYCorr;
|
|
aPaintEnd.Y() -= nTwipYCorr;
|
|
|
|
// Here comes the painting stuff: Thank you, DR, great job!!!
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
mrTabFrm.ProcessPrimitives( svx::frame::CreateBorderPrimitives(
|
|
aPaintStart,
|
|
aPaintEnd,
|
|
aStyles[ 0 ], // current style
|
|
aStyles[ 1 ], // aLFromT
|
|
aStyles[ 2 ], // aLFromL
|
|
aStyles[ 3 ], // aLFromB
|
|
aStyles[ 4 ], // aRFromT
|
|
aStyles[ 5 ], // aRFromR
|
|
aStyles[ 6 ], // aRFromB
|
|
pTmpColor
|
|
)
|
|
);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
mrTabFrm.ProcessPrimitives( svx::frame::CreateBorderPrimitives(
|
|
aPaintEnd,
|
|
aPaintStart,
|
|
aStyles[ 0 ], // current style
|
|
aStyles[ 4 ], // aBFromL
|
|
aStyles[ 5 ], // aBFromB
|
|
aStyles[ 6 ], // aBFromR
|
|
aStyles[ 1 ], // aTFromL
|
|
aStyles[ 2 ], // aTFromT
|
|
aStyles[ 3 ], // aTFromR
|
|
pTmpColor
|
|
)
|
|
);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
++aSetIter;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// restore output device:
|
|
rDev.Pop();
|
|
rDev.SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Finds the lines that join the line defined by (StartPoint, EndPoint) in either
|
|
// StartPoint or Endpoint. The styles of these lines are required for DR's magic
|
|
// line painting functions.
|
|
void SwTabFrmPainter::FindStylesForLine( const Point& rStartPoint,
|
|
const Point& rEndPoint,
|
|
svx::frame::Style* pStyles,
|
|
bool bHori ) const
|
|
{
|
|
// pStyles[ 1 ] = bHori ? aLFromT : TFromL
|
|
// pStyles[ 2 ] = bHori ? aLFromL : TFromT,
|
|
// pStyles[ 3 ] = bHori ? aLFromB : TFromR,
|
|
// pStyles[ 4 ] = bHori ? aRFromT : BFromL,
|
|
// pStyles[ 5 ] = bHori ? aRFromR : BFromB,
|
|
// pStyles[ 6 ] = bHori ? aRFromB : BFromR,
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntryMapConstIter aMapIter = maVertLines.find( rStartPoint.X() );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aMapIter != maVertLines.end(), "FindStylesForLine: Error" );
|
|
const SwLineEntrySet& rVertSet = (*aMapIter).second;
|
|
SwLineEntrySetConstIter aIter = rVertSet.begin();
|
|
|
|
while ( aIter != rVertSet.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rEntry = *aIter;
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rStartPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 3 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rStartPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 1 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rStartPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 2 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rEndPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 5 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
}
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
aMapIter = maHoriLines.find( rStartPoint.Y() );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aMapIter != maHoriLines.end(), "FindStylesForLine: Error" );
|
|
const SwLineEntrySet& rHoriSet = (*aMapIter).second;
|
|
aIter = rHoriSet.begin();
|
|
|
|
while ( aIter != rHoriSet.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rEntry = *aIter;
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rStartPoint.X() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 2 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rEndPoint.X() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 5 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( rStartPoint.X() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 1 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rStartPoint.X() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 3 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
}
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
aMapIter = maVertLines.find( rEndPoint.X() );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aMapIter != maVertLines.end(), "FindStylesForLine: Error" );
|
|
const SwLineEntrySet& rVertSet2 = (*aMapIter).second;
|
|
aIter = rVertSet2.begin();
|
|
|
|
while ( aIter != rVertSet2.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rEntry = *aIter;
|
|
if ( rEndPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 6 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rEndPoint.Y() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 4 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aMapIter = maHoriLines.find( rEndPoint.Y() );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( aMapIter != maHoriLines.end(), "FindStylesForLine: Error" );
|
|
const SwLineEntrySet& rHoriSet2 = (*aMapIter).second;
|
|
aIter = rHoriSet2.begin();
|
|
|
|
while ( aIter != rHoriSet2.end() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rEntry = *aIter;
|
|
if ( rEndPoint.X() == rEntry.mnEndPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 4 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
else if ( rEndPoint.X() == rEntry.mnStartPos )
|
|
pStyles[ 6 ] = rEntry.maAttribute;
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwTabFrmPainter::Insert( const SwFrm& rFrm, const SvxBoxItem& rBoxItem )
|
|
{
|
|
std::vector< const SwFrm* > aTestVec;
|
|
aTestVec.push_back( &rFrm );
|
|
aTestVec.push_back( &rFrm );
|
|
aTestVec.push_back( &rFrm );
|
|
|
|
// build 4 line entries for the 4 borders:
|
|
SwRect aBorderRect = rFrm.Frm();
|
|
if ( rFrm.IsTabFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
aBorderRect = rFrm.Prt();
|
|
aBorderRect.Pos() += rFrm.Frm().Pos();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const SwTwips nLeft = aBorderRect._Left();
|
|
const SwTwips nRight = aBorderRect._Right();
|
|
const SwTwips nTop = aBorderRect._Top();
|
|
const SwTwips nBottom = aBorderRect._Bottom();
|
|
|
|
svx::frame::Style aL( rBoxItem.GetLeft() );
|
|
svx::frame::Style aR( rBoxItem.GetRight() );
|
|
svx::frame::Style aT( rBoxItem.GetTop() );
|
|
svx::frame::Style aB( rBoxItem.GetBottom() );
|
|
|
|
const SwTwips nHalfTopWidth = aT.GetWidth() / 2;
|
|
|
|
aR.MirrorSelf();
|
|
aB.MirrorSelf();
|
|
|
|
bool bVert = mrTabFrm.IsVertical();
|
|
bool bR2L = mrTabFrm.IsRightToLeft();
|
|
|
|
aL.SetRefMode( svx::frame::REFMODE_CENTERED );
|
|
aR.SetRefMode( svx::frame::REFMODE_CENTERED );
|
|
aT.SetRefMode( !bVert ? svx::frame::REFMODE_BEGIN : svx::frame::REFMODE_END );
|
|
aB.SetRefMode( !bVert ? svx::frame::REFMODE_BEGIN : svx::frame::REFMODE_END );
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntry aLeft ( nLeft, nTop + nHalfTopWidth, nBottom + nHalfTopWidth, bVert ? aB : ( bR2L ? aR : aL ) );
|
|
SwLineEntry aRight ( nRight, nTop + nHalfTopWidth, nBottom + nHalfTopWidth, bVert ? aT : ( bR2L ? aL : aR ) );
|
|
SwLineEntry aTop ( nTop + nHalfTopWidth, nLeft, nRight, bVert ? aL : aT );
|
|
SwLineEntry aBottom( nBottom + nHalfTopWidth, nLeft, nRight, bVert ? aR : aB );
|
|
|
|
Insert( aLeft, false );
|
|
Insert( aRight, false );
|
|
Insert( aTop, true );
|
|
Insert( aBottom, true );
|
|
|
|
const SwRowFrm* pThisRowFrm = dynamic_cast<const SwRowFrm*>(rFrm.GetUpper());
|
|
|
|
// special case: #i9860#
|
|
// first line in follow table without repeated headlines
|
|
if ( pThisRowFrm &&
|
|
pThisRowFrm->GetUpper() == &mrTabFrm &&
|
|
mrTabFrm.IsFollow() &&
|
|
!mrTabFrm.GetTable()->GetRowsToRepeat() &&
|
|
(!pThisRowFrm->GetPrev() || static_cast<const SwRowFrm*>(pThisRowFrm->GetPrev())->IsRowSpanLine()) &&
|
|
!rBoxItem.GetTop() &&
|
|
rBoxItem.GetBottom() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineEntry aFollowTop( !bVert ? nTop : nRight, !bVert ? nLeft : nTop, !bVert ? nRight : nBottom, aB );
|
|
Insert( aFollowTop, !bVert );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwTabFrmPainter::Insert( SwLineEntry& rNew, bool bHori )
|
|
{
|
|
// get all lines from structure, that have key entry of pLE
|
|
SwLineEntryMap* pLine2 = bHori ? &maHoriLines : &maVertLines;
|
|
const SwTwips nKey = rNew.mnKey;
|
|
SwLineEntryMapIter aMapIter = pLine2->find( nKey );
|
|
|
|
SwLineEntrySet* pLineSet = aMapIter != pLine2->end() ? &((*aMapIter).second) : 0;
|
|
if ( !pLineSet )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLineEntrySet aNewSet;
|
|
(*pLine2)[ nKey ] = aNewSet;
|
|
pLineSet = &(*pLine2)[ nKey ];
|
|
}
|
|
SwLineEntrySetIter aIter = pLineSet->begin();
|
|
|
|
while ( pLineSet && aIter != pLineSet->end() && rNew.mnStartPos < rNew.mnEndPos )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineEntry& rOld = *aIter;
|
|
const SwLineEntry::OverlapType nOverlapType = rOld.Overlaps( rNew );
|
|
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rOldAttr = rOld.maAttribute;
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rNewAttr = rNew.maAttribute;
|
|
const svx::frame::Style& rCmpAttr = rNewAttr > rOldAttr ? rNewAttr : rOldAttr;
|
|
|
|
if ( SwLineEntry::OVERLAP1 == nOverlapType )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( rNew.mnStartPos >= rOld.mnStartPos, "Overlap type 3? How this?" );
|
|
|
|
// new left segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aLeft( nKey, rOld.mnStartPos, rNew.mnStartPos, rOldAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new middle segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aMiddle( nKey, rNew.mnStartPos, rOld.mnEndPos, rCmpAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new right segment
|
|
rNew.mnStartPos = rOld.mnEndPos;
|
|
|
|
// update current lines set
|
|
pLineSet->erase( aIter );
|
|
if ( aLeft.mnStartPos < aLeft.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aLeft );
|
|
if ( aMiddle.mnStartPos < aMiddle.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aMiddle );
|
|
|
|
aIter = pLineSet->begin();
|
|
|
|
continue; // start over
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( SwLineEntry::OVERLAP2 == nOverlapType )
|
|
{
|
|
// new left segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aLeft( nKey, rOld.mnStartPos, rNew.mnStartPos, rOldAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new middle segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aMiddle( nKey, rNew.mnStartPos, rNew.mnEndPos, rCmpAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new right segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aRight( nKey, rNew.mnEndPos, rOld.mnEndPos, rOldAttr );
|
|
|
|
// update current lines set
|
|
pLineSet->erase( aIter );
|
|
if ( aLeft.mnStartPos < aLeft.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aLeft );
|
|
if ( aMiddle.mnStartPos < aMiddle.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aMiddle );
|
|
if ( aRight.mnStartPos < aRight.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aRight );
|
|
|
|
rNew.mnStartPos = rNew.mnEndPos; // rNew should not be inserted!
|
|
|
|
break; // we are finished
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( SwLineEntry::OVERLAP3 == nOverlapType )
|
|
{
|
|
// new left segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aLeft( nKey, rNew.mnStartPos, rOld.mnStartPos, rNewAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new middle segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aMiddle( nKey, rOld.mnStartPos, rNew.mnEndPos, rCmpAttr );
|
|
|
|
// new right segment
|
|
const SwLineEntry aRight( nKey, rNew.mnEndPos, rOld.mnEndPos, rOldAttr );
|
|
|
|
// update current lines set
|
|
pLineSet->erase( aIter );
|
|
if ( aLeft.mnStartPos < aLeft.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aLeft );
|
|
if ( aMiddle.mnStartPos < aMiddle.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aMiddle );
|
|
if ( aRight.mnStartPos < aRight.mnEndPos ) pLineSet->insert( aRight );
|
|
|
|
rNew.mnStartPos = rNew.mnEndPos; // rNew should not be inserted!
|
|
|
|
break; // we are finished
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
++aIter;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rNew.mnStartPos < rNew.mnEndPos ) // insert rest
|
|
pLineSet->insert( rNew );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
// FUNCTIONS USED FOR COLLAPSING TABLE BORDER LINES END
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// --> OD #i76669#
|
|
namespace
|
|
{
|
|
class SwViewObjectContactRedirector : public ::sdr::contact::ViewObjectContactRedirector
|
|
{
|
|
private:
|
|
const ViewShell& mrViewShell;
|
|
|
|
public:
|
|
SwViewObjectContactRedirector( const ViewShell& rSh )
|
|
: mrViewShell( rSh )
|
|
{};
|
|
|
|
virtual ~SwViewObjectContactRedirector()
|
|
{}
|
|
|
|
virtual drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence createRedirectedPrimitive2DSequence(
|
|
const sdr::contact::ViewObjectContact& rOriginal,
|
|
const sdr::contact::DisplayInfo& rDisplayInfo)
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Bool bPaint( sal_True );
|
|
|
|
SdrObject* pObj = rOriginal.GetViewContact().TryToGetSdrObject();
|
|
if ( pObj )
|
|
{
|
|
bPaint = SwFlyFrm::IsPaint( pObj, &mrViewShell );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !bPaint )
|
|
{
|
|
return drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return sdr::contact::ViewObjectContactRedirector::createRedirectedPrimitive2DSequence(
|
|
rOriginal, rDisplayInfo );
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
} // end of anonymous namespace
|
|
// <--
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwRootFrm::Paint()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung
|
|
|* Fuer jede sichtbare Seite, die von Rect ber?hrt wird einmal Painten.
|
|
|* 1. Umrandungen und Hintergruende Painten.
|
|
|* 2. Den Draw Layer (Ramen und Zeichenobjekte) der unter dem Dokument
|
|
|* liegt painten (Hoelle).
|
|
|* 3. Den Dokumentinhalt (Text) Painten.
|
|
|* 4. Den Drawlayer der ueber dem Dokuemnt liegt painten.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
SwRootFrm::Paint(SwRect const& rRect, SwPrintData const*const pPrintData) const
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( Lower() && Lower()->IsPageFrm(), "Lower der Root keine Seite." );
|
|
|
|
PROTOCOL( this, PROT_FILE_INIT, 0, 0)
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bResetRootPaint = sal_False;
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = pCurrShell;
|
|
|
|
if ( pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pSh->GetOut() == pSh->GetWin() && !pSh->GetWin()->IsVisible() )
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( SwRootFrm::bInPaint )
|
|
{
|
|
SwPaintQueue::Add( pSh, rRect );
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
SwRootFrm::bInPaint = bResetRootPaint = sal_True;
|
|
|
|
SwSavePaintStatics *pStatics = 0;
|
|
if ( pGlobalShell )
|
|
pStatics = new SwSavePaintStatics();
|
|
pGlobalShell = pSh;
|
|
|
|
if( !pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
pProgress = SfxProgress::GetActiveProgress( (SfxObjectShell*) pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell() );
|
|
|
|
::SwCalcPixStatics( pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
aGlobalRetoucheColor = pSh->Imp()->GetRetoucheColor();
|
|
|
|
//Ggf. eine Action ausloesen um klare Verhaeltnisse zu schaffen.
|
|
//Durch diesen Kunstgriff kann in allen Paints davon ausgegangen werden,
|
|
//das alle Werte gueltigt sind - keine Probleme, keine Sonderbehandlung(en).
|
|
// #i92745#
|
|
// Extend check on certain states of the 'current' <ViewShell> instance to
|
|
// all existing <ViewShell> instances.
|
|
bool bPerformLayoutAction( true );
|
|
{
|
|
ViewShell* pTmpViewShell = pSh;
|
|
do {
|
|
if ( pTmpViewShell->IsInEndAction() ||
|
|
pTmpViewShell->IsPaintInProgress() ||
|
|
( pTmpViewShell->Imp()->IsAction() &&
|
|
pTmpViewShell->Imp()->GetLayAction().IsActionInProgress() ) )
|
|
{
|
|
bPerformLayoutAction = false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pTmpViewShell = static_cast<ViewShell*>(pTmpViewShell->GetNext());
|
|
} while ( bPerformLayoutAction && pTmpViewShell != pSh );
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bPerformLayoutAction )
|
|
{
|
|
((SwRootFrm*)this)->ResetTurbo();
|
|
SwLayAction aAction( (SwRootFrm*)this, pSh->Imp() );
|
|
aAction.SetPaint( sal_False );
|
|
aAction.SetComplete( sal_False );
|
|
aAction.SetReschedule( pProgress ? sal_True : sal_False );
|
|
aAction.Action();
|
|
((SwRootFrm*)this)->ResetTurboFlag();
|
|
if ( !pSh->ActionPend() )
|
|
pSh->Imp()->DelRegion();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
aRect.Intersection( pSh->VisArea() );
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bExtraData = ::IsExtraData( GetFmt()->GetDoc() );
|
|
|
|
pLines = new SwLineRects; //Sammler fuer Umrandungen.
|
|
|
|
// #104289#. During painting, something (OLE) can
|
|
// load the linguistic, which in turn can cause a reformat
|
|
// of the document. Dangerous! We better set this flag to
|
|
// avoid the reformat.
|
|
const sal_Bool bOldAction = IsCallbackActionEnabled();
|
|
((SwRootFrm*)this)->SetCallbackActionEnabled( sal_False );
|
|
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage = pSh->Imp()->GetFirstVisPage();
|
|
|
|
const bool bBookMode = pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsViewLayoutBookMode();
|
|
if ( bBookMode && pPage->GetPrev() && static_cast<const SwPageFrm*>(pPage->GetPrev())->IsEmptyPage() )
|
|
pPage = static_cast<const SwPageFrm*>(pPage->GetPrev());
|
|
|
|
// #i68597#
|
|
const bool bGridPainting(pSh->GetWin() && pSh->Imp()->HasDrawView() && pSh->Imp()->GetDrawView()->IsGridVisible());
|
|
|
|
// #i76669#
|
|
SwViewObjectContactRedirector aSwRedirector( *pSh );
|
|
|
|
while ( pPage )
|
|
{
|
|
const bool bPaintRightShadow = pPage->IsRightShadowNeeded();
|
|
const bool bPaintLeftShadow = pPage->IsLeftShadowNeeded();
|
|
const bool bRightSidebar = pPage->SidebarPosition() == sw::sidebarwindows::SIDEBAR_RIGHT;
|
|
|
|
if ( !pPage->IsEmptyPage() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect;
|
|
SwPageFrm::GetBorderAndShadowBoundRect( pPage->Frm(), pSh, aPaintRect,
|
|
bPaintLeftShadow, bPaintRightShadow, bRightSidebar );
|
|
|
|
if ( aRect.IsOver( aPaintRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
pSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
pSpecSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
aPaintRect._Intersection( aRect );
|
|
|
|
if ( bExtraData &&
|
|
pSh->GetWin() && pSh->IsInEndAction() )
|
|
{
|
|
// enlarge paint rectangle to complete page width, subtract
|
|
// current paint area and invalidate the resulting region.
|
|
SWRECTFN( pPage )
|
|
SwRect aPageRectTemp( aPaintRect );
|
|
(aPageRectTemp.*fnRect->fnSetLeftAndWidth)(
|
|
(pPage->Frm().*fnRect->fnGetLeft)(),
|
|
(pPage->Frm().*fnRect->fnGetWidth)() );
|
|
aPageRectTemp._Intersection( pSh->VisArea() );
|
|
Region aPageRectRegion( aPageRectTemp.SVRect() );
|
|
aPageRectRegion.Exclude( aPaintRect.SVRect() );
|
|
pSh->GetWin()->Invalidate( aPageRectRegion, INVALIDATE_CHILDREN );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// #i80793#
|
|
// enlarge paint rectangle for objects overlapping the same pixel
|
|
// in all cases and before the DrawingLayer overlay is initialized.
|
|
lcl_AdjustRectToPixelSize( aPaintRect, *(pSh->GetOut()) );
|
|
|
|
// #i68597#
|
|
// moved paint pre-process for DrawingLayer overlay here since the above
|
|
// code dependent from bExtraData may expand the PaintRect
|
|
{
|
|
// #i75172# if called from ViewShell::ImplEndAction it sould no longer
|
|
// really be used but handled by ViewShell::ImplEndAction already
|
|
const Region aDLRegion(aPaintRect.SVRect());
|
|
pSh->DLPrePaint2(aDLRegion);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if(OUTDEV_WINDOW == pGlobalShell->GetOut()->GetOutDevType())
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 27.09.2002 #103636# - changed method SwLayVout::Enter(..)
|
|
/// 2nd parameter is no longer <const> and will be set to the
|
|
/// rectangle the virtual output device is calculated from <aPaintRect>,
|
|
/// if the virtual output is used.
|
|
pVout->Enter( pSh, aPaintRect, !bNoVirDev );
|
|
|
|
/// OD 27.09.2002 #103636# - adjust paint rectangle to pixel size
|
|
/// Thus, all objects overlapping on pixel level with the unadjusted
|
|
/// paint rectangle will be considered in the paint.
|
|
lcl_AdjustRectToPixelSize( aPaintRect, *(pSh->GetOut()) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// maybe this can be put in the above scope. Since we are not sure, just leave it ATM
|
|
pVout->SetOrgRect( aPaintRect );
|
|
|
|
/// OD 29.08.2002 #102450#
|
|
/// determine background color of page for <PaintLayer> method
|
|
/// calls, paint <hell> or <heaven>
|
|
const Color aPageBackgrdColor = pPage->GetDrawBackgrdColor();
|
|
|
|
pPage->PaintBaBo( aPaintRect, pPage, sal_True );
|
|
|
|
if ( pSh->Imp()->HasDrawView() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLines->LockLines( sal_True );
|
|
const IDocumentDrawModelAccess* pIDDMA = pSh->getIDocumentDrawModelAccess();
|
|
pSh->Imp()->PaintLayer( pIDDMA->GetHellId(),
|
|
pPrintData,
|
|
aPaintRect,
|
|
&aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
pLines->LockLines( sal_False );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if( pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
// collect sub-lines
|
|
pPage->RefreshSubsidiary( aPaintRect );
|
|
// paint special sub-lines
|
|
pSpecSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pSh->GetOut(), NULL );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pPage->Paint( aPaintRect );
|
|
|
|
// no paint of page border and shadow, if writer is in place mode.
|
|
if( pSh->GetWin() && pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell() &&
|
|
!pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell()->IsInPlaceActive() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwPageFrm::PaintBorderAndShadow( pPage->Frm(), pSh, bPaintLeftShadow, bPaintRightShadow, bRightSidebar );
|
|
SwPageFrm::PaintNotesSidebar( pPage->Frm(), pSh, pPage->GetPhyPageNum(), bRightSidebar);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
|
|
if ( pSh->Imp()->HasDrawView() )
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 29.08.2002 #102450# - add 3rd parameter
|
|
// OD 09.12.2002 #103045# - add 4th parameter for horizontal text direction.
|
|
pSh->Imp()->PaintLayer( pSh->GetDoc()->GetHeavenId(),
|
|
pPrintData,
|
|
aPaintRect,
|
|
&aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bExtraData )
|
|
pPage->RefreshExtraData( aPaintRect );
|
|
|
|
pPage->PaintDecorators( );
|
|
|
|
if ( pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
pSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pSh->GetOut(), pLines );
|
|
DELETEZ( pSubsLines );
|
|
DELETEZ( pSpecSubsLines );
|
|
}
|
|
pVout->Leave();
|
|
|
|
// #i68597#
|
|
// needed to move grid painting inside Begin/EndDrawLayer bounds and to change
|
|
// output rect for it accordingly
|
|
if(bGridPainting)
|
|
{
|
|
SdrPaintView* pPaintView = pSh->Imp()->GetDrawView();
|
|
SdrPageView* pPageView = pPaintView->GetSdrPageView();
|
|
pPageView->DrawPageViewGrid(*pSh->GetOut(), aPaintRect.SVRect(), SwViewOption::GetTextGridColor() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// #i68597#
|
|
// moved paint post-process for DrawingLayer overlay here, see above
|
|
{
|
|
pSh->DLPostPaint2(true);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( bBookMode && pSh->GetWin() && !pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell()->IsInPlaceActive() )
|
|
{
|
|
// paint empty page
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect;
|
|
SwRect aEmptyPageRect( pPage->Frm() );
|
|
|
|
// code from vprint.cxx
|
|
const SwPageFrm& rFormatPage = pPage->GetFormatPage();
|
|
aEmptyPageRect.SSize() = rFormatPage.Frm().SSize();
|
|
|
|
SwPageFrm::GetBorderAndShadowBoundRect( aEmptyPageRect, pSh, aPaintRect,
|
|
bPaintLeftShadow, bPaintRightShadow, bRightSidebar );
|
|
aPaintRect._Intersection( aRect );
|
|
|
|
if ( aRect.IsOver( aEmptyPageRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// #i75172# if called from ViewShell::ImplEndAction it sould no longer
|
|
// really be used but handled by ViewShell::ImplEndAction already
|
|
{
|
|
const Region aDLRegion(aPaintRect.SVRect());
|
|
pSh->DLPrePaint2(aDLRegion);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if( pSh->GetOut()->GetFillColor() != aGlobalRetoucheColor )
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->SetFillColor( aGlobalRetoucheColor );
|
|
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->SetLineColor(); // OD 20.02.2003 #107369# - no line color
|
|
// OD 20.02.2003 #107369# - use aligned page rectangle
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aTmpPageRect( aEmptyPageRect );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aTmpPageRect, pSh );
|
|
aEmptyPageRect = aTmpPageRect;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->DrawRect( aEmptyPageRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
// paint empty page text
|
|
const Font& rEmptyPageFont = SwPageFrm::GetEmptyPageFont();
|
|
const Font aOldFont( pSh->GetOut()->GetFont() );
|
|
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->SetFont( rEmptyPageFont );
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->DrawText( aEmptyPageRect.SVRect(), SW_RESSTR( STR_EMPTYPAGE ),
|
|
TEXT_DRAW_VCENTER |
|
|
TEXT_DRAW_CENTER |
|
|
TEXT_DRAW_CLIP );
|
|
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->SetFont( aOldFont );
|
|
// paint shadow and border for empty page
|
|
// OD 19.02.2003 #107369# - use new method to paint page border and
|
|
// shadow
|
|
SwPageFrm::PaintBorderAndShadow( aEmptyPageRect, pSh, bPaintLeftShadow, bPaintRightShadow, bRightSidebar );
|
|
SwPageFrm::PaintNotesSidebar( aEmptyPageRect, pSh, pPage->GetPhyPageNum(), bRightSidebar);
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
pSh->DLPostPaint2(true);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( !pPage->GetNext() || pPage->GetNext()->IsPageFrm(),
|
|
"Nachbar von Seite keine Seite." );
|
|
pPage = (SwPageFrm*)pPage->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
DELETEZ( pLines );
|
|
|
|
if ( bResetRootPaint )
|
|
SwRootFrm::bInPaint = sal_False;
|
|
if ( pStatics )
|
|
delete pStatics;
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
pProgress = 0;
|
|
pGlobalShell = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
((SwRootFrm*)this)->SetCallbackActionEnabled( bOldAction );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwLayoutFrm::Paint()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_EmergencyFormatFtnCont( SwFtnContFrm *pCont )
|
|
{
|
|
//Es kann sein, dass der Cont vernichtet wird.
|
|
SwCntntFrm *pCnt = pCont->ContainsCntnt();
|
|
while ( pCnt && pCnt->IsInFtn() )
|
|
{
|
|
pCnt->Calc();
|
|
pCnt = pCnt->GetNextCntntFrm();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
class SwShortCut
|
|
{
|
|
SwRectDist fnCheck;
|
|
long nLimit;
|
|
public:
|
|
SwShortCut( const SwFrm& rFrm, const SwRect& rRect );
|
|
sal_Bool Stop( const SwRect& rRect ) const
|
|
{ return (rRect.*fnCheck)( nLimit ) > 0; }
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
SwShortCut::SwShortCut( const SwFrm& rFrm, const SwRect& rRect )
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Bool bVert = rFrm.IsVertical();
|
|
sal_Bool bR2L = rFrm.IsRightToLeft();
|
|
if( rFrm.IsNeighbourFrm() && bVert == bR2L )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
fnCheck = &SwRect::GetBottomDistance;
|
|
nLimit = rRect.Top();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
fnCheck = &SwRect::GetLeftDistance;
|
|
nLimit = rRect.Left() + rRect.Width();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if( bVert == rFrm.IsNeighbourFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
fnCheck = &SwRect::GetTopDistance;
|
|
nLimit = rRect.Top() + rRect.Height();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
//Badaa: 2008-04-18 * Support for Classical Mongolian Script (SCMS) joint with Jiayanmin
|
|
if ( rFrm.IsVertLR() )
|
|
{
|
|
fnCheck = &SwRect::GetLeftDistance;
|
|
nLimit = rRect.Right();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
fnCheck = &SwRect::GetRightDistance;
|
|
nLimit = rRect.Left();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLayoutFrm::Paint(SwRect const& rRect, SwPrintData const*const) const
|
|
{
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
Frm_Info aFrmInfo( *this );
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, &aFrmInfo, 0, *pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm *pFrm = Lower();
|
|
if ( !pFrm )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
SwShortCut aShortCut( *pFrm, rRect );
|
|
sal_Bool bCnt;
|
|
if ( sal_True == (bCnt = pFrm->IsCntntFrm()) )
|
|
pFrm->Calc();
|
|
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsFtnContFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
::lcl_EmergencyFormatFtnCont( (SwFtnContFrm*)pFrm );
|
|
pFrm = Lower();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage = 0;
|
|
const sal_Bool bWin = pGlobalShell->GetWin() ? sal_True : sal_False;
|
|
|
|
while ( IsAnLower( pFrm ) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect( pFrm->PaintArea() );
|
|
if( aShortCut.Stop( aPaintRect ) )
|
|
break;
|
|
if ( bCnt && pProgress )
|
|
pProgress->Reschedule();
|
|
|
|
//Wenn ein Frm es explizit will muss retouchiert werden.
|
|
//Erst die Retouche, denn selbige koennte die aligned'en Raender
|
|
//plaetten.
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsRetouche() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsRetoucheFrm() && bWin && !pFrm->GetNext() )
|
|
{ if ( !pPage )
|
|
pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
pFrm->Retouche( pPage, rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
pFrm->ResetRetouche();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( rRect.IsOver( aPaintRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bCnt && pFrm->IsCompletePaint() &&
|
|
!rRect.IsInside( aPaintRect ) && GetpApp()->AnyInput( INPUT_KEYBOARD ) )
|
|
{
|
|
//fix(8104): Es kann vorkommen, dass die Verarbeitung nicht
|
|
//vollstaendig war, aber trotzdem Teile des Absatzes gepaintet
|
|
//werden. In der Folge werden dann evtl. wiederum andere Teile
|
|
//des Absatzes garnicht mehr gepaintet. Einziger Ausweg scheint
|
|
//hier ein Invalidieren der Windows zu sein.
|
|
//Um es nicht alzu Heftig werden zu lassen versuche ich hier
|
|
//das Rechteck zu begrenzen indem der gewuenschte Teil gepaintet
|
|
//und nur die uebrigen Absatzanteile invalidiert werden.
|
|
if ( aPaintRect.Left() == rRect.Left() &&
|
|
aPaintRect.Right() == rRect.Right() )
|
|
{
|
|
aPaintRect.Bottom( rRect.Top() - 1 );
|
|
if ( aPaintRect.Height() > 0 )
|
|
pGlobalShell->InvalidateWindows(aPaintRect);
|
|
aPaintRect.Top( rRect.Bottom() + 1 );
|
|
aPaintRect.Bottom( pFrm->Frm().Bottom() );
|
|
if ( aPaintRect.Height() > 0 )
|
|
pGlobalShell->InvalidateWindows(aPaintRect);
|
|
aPaintRect.Top( pFrm->Frm().Top() );
|
|
aPaintRect.Bottom( pFrm->Frm().Bottom() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
pGlobalShell->InvalidateWindows( aPaintRect );
|
|
pFrm = pFrm->GetNext();
|
|
if ( pFrm && (sal_True == (bCnt = pFrm->IsCntntFrm())) )
|
|
pFrm->Calc();
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
pFrm->ResetCompletePaint();
|
|
aPaintRect._Intersection( rRect );
|
|
|
|
pFrm->Paint( aPaintRect );
|
|
|
|
if ( Lower() && Lower()->IsColumnFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
//Ggf. die Spaltentrennlinien malen. Fuer den Seitenbody ist
|
|
//nicht der Upper sondern die Seite Zustaendig.
|
|
const SwFrmFmt *pFmt = GetUpper() && GetUpper()->IsPageFrm()
|
|
? GetUpper()->GetFmt()
|
|
: GetFmt();
|
|
const SwFmtCol &rCol = pFmt->GetCol();
|
|
if ( rCol.GetLineAdj() != COLADJ_NONE )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pPage )
|
|
pPage = pFrm->FindPageFrm();
|
|
|
|
PaintColLines( aPaintRect, rCol, pPage );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( !bCnt && pFrm->GetNext() && pFrm->GetNext()->IsFtnContFrm() )
|
|
::lcl_EmergencyFormatFtnCont( (SwFtnContFrm*)pFrm->GetNext() );
|
|
|
|
pFrm = pFrm->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
if ( pFrm && (sal_True == (bCnt = pFrm->IsCntntFrm())) )
|
|
pFrm->Calc();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence lcl_CreateDashedIndicatorPrimitive(
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aStart, basegfx::B2DPoint aEnd,
|
|
basegfx::BColor aColor )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSeq( 1 );
|
|
|
|
std::vector< double > aStrokePattern;
|
|
basegfx::B2DPolygon aLinePolygon;
|
|
aLinePolygon.append( aStart );
|
|
aLinePolygon.append( aEnd );
|
|
|
|
const StyleSettings& rSettings = Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings();
|
|
if ( rSettings.GetHighContrastMode( ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// Only a solid line in high contrast mode
|
|
aColor = rSettings.GetDialogTextColor().getBColor();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// Get a color for the contrast
|
|
basegfx::BColor aHslLine = basegfx::tools::rgb2hsl( aColor );
|
|
double nLuminance = aHslLine.getZ() * 2.5;
|
|
if ( nLuminance == 0 )
|
|
nLuminance = 0.5;
|
|
else if ( nLuminance >= 1.0 )
|
|
nLuminance = aHslLine.getZ() * 0.4;
|
|
aHslLine.setZ( nLuminance );
|
|
const basegfx::BColor aOtherColor = basegfx::tools::hsl2rgb( aHslLine );
|
|
|
|
// Compute the plain line
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D * pPlainLine =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D(
|
|
aLinePolygon, aOtherColor );
|
|
|
|
aSeq[0] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pPlainLine );
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Dashed line in twips
|
|
aStrokePattern.push_back( 40 );
|
|
aStrokePattern.push_back( 40 );
|
|
|
|
aSeq.realloc( 2 );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Compute the dashed line primitive
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolyPolygonStrokePrimitive2D * pLine =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolyPolygonStrokePrimitive2D (
|
|
basegfx::B2DPolyPolygon( aLinePolygon ),
|
|
drawinglayer::attribute::LineAttribute( aColor ),
|
|
drawinglayer::attribute::StrokeAttribute( aStrokePattern ) );
|
|
|
|
aSeq[ aSeq.getLength( ) - 1 ] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pLine );
|
|
|
|
return aSeq;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence lcl_CreateHeaderFooterSeparatorPrimitives(
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pPageFrm, double nLineY )
|
|
{
|
|
// Adjust the Y-coordinate of the line to the header/footer box
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aLeft ( pPageFrm->Frm().Left(), nLineY );
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aRight( pPageFrm->Frm().Right(), nLineY );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::BColor aLineColor = SwViewOption::GetHeaderFooterMarkColor().getBColor();
|
|
|
|
return lcl_CreateDashedIndicatorPrimitive( aLeft, aRight, aLineColor );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::PaintBreak( ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPrinting() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPDFExport() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->IsPreView() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pBodyFrm = Lower();
|
|
while ( pBodyFrm && !pBodyFrm->IsBodyFrm() )
|
|
pBodyFrm = pBodyFrm->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
if ( pBodyFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwCntntFrm *pCnt = static_cast< const SwLayoutFrm* >( pBodyFrm )->ContainsCntnt();
|
|
if ( pCnt && pCnt->IsPageBreak( sal_True ) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pPageFrm = FindPageFrm();
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pPrevPageFrm = static_cast< const SwPageFrm* >( pPageFrm->GetPrev() );
|
|
|
|
double nYLineOffset = double( pPageFrm->Frm().Top() + pPrevPageFrm->Frm().Bottom() ) / 2.0;
|
|
SwRect aRect = pPageFrm->GetBoundRect();
|
|
|
|
basegfx::BColor aColor = SwViewOption::GetPageBreakColor().getBColor();
|
|
|
|
// Draw the line
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSeq =
|
|
lcl_CreateDashedIndicatorPrimitive(
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint( double( aRect.Left() ), nYLineOffset ),
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint( double( aRect.Right() ), nYLineOffset ),
|
|
aColor );
|
|
|
|
aSeq.realloc( aSeq.getLength() + 1 );
|
|
|
|
// Add the text above
|
|
rtl::OUString aBreakText = ResId::toString( SW_RES( STR_PAGE_BREAK ) );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aFontSize;
|
|
OutputDevice* pOut = pGlobalShell->GetOut();
|
|
Font aFont = pOut->GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetToolFont();
|
|
aFont.SetHeight( 8 * 20 );
|
|
pOut->SetFont( aFont );
|
|
drawinglayer::attribute::FontAttribute aFontAttr = drawinglayer::primitive2d::getFontAttributeFromVclFont(
|
|
aFontSize, aFont, false, false );
|
|
|
|
Rectangle aTextRect;
|
|
pOut->GetTextBoundRect( aTextRect, String( aBreakText ) );
|
|
long nTextOff = ( aRect.Width() - aTextRect.GetWidth() ) / 2;
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DHomMatrix aTextMatrix( basegfx::tools::createScaleTranslateB2DHomMatrix(
|
|
aFontSize.getX(), aFontSize.getY(),
|
|
aRect.Left() + nTextOff, nYLineOffset ) );
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::TextSimplePortionPrimitive2D * pText =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::TextSimplePortionPrimitive2D(
|
|
aTextMatrix,
|
|
aBreakText, 0, aBreakText.getLength(),
|
|
std::vector< double >(),
|
|
aFontAttr,
|
|
lang::Locale(),
|
|
aColor );
|
|
aSeq[ aSeq.getLength() - 1 ] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pText );
|
|
|
|
ProcessPrimitives( aSeq );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwColumnFrm::PaintBreak( ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPrinting() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPDFExport() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->IsPreView() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pBodyFrm = Lower();
|
|
while ( pBodyFrm && !pBodyFrm->IsBodyFrm() )
|
|
pBodyFrm = pBodyFrm->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
if ( pBodyFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwCntntFrm *pCnt = static_cast< const SwLayoutFrm* >( pBodyFrm )->ContainsCntnt();
|
|
if ( pCnt && pCnt->IsColBreak( sal_True ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// Paint the break only if:
|
|
// * Not in header footer edition, to avoid conflicts with the
|
|
// header/footer marker
|
|
// * Non-printing characters are shown, as this is more consistent
|
|
// with other formatting marks
|
|
if ( !pGlobalShell->IsShowHeaderFooterSeparator() &&
|
|
pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions( )->IsLineBreak( ) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect( pCnt->Prt() );
|
|
aRect.Pos() += pCnt->Frm().Pos();
|
|
|
|
// Draw the line
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aStart( double( aRect.Left() ), aRect.Top() );
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aEnd( double( aRect.Right() ), aRect.Top() );
|
|
double nWidth = aRect.Width();
|
|
if ( IsVertical( ) )
|
|
{
|
|
aStart = basegfx::B2DPoint( double( aRect.Right() ), double( aRect.Top() ) );
|
|
aEnd = basegfx::B2DPoint( double( aRect.Right() ), double( aRect.Bottom() ) );
|
|
nWidth = aRect.Height();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
basegfx::BColor aLineColor = SwViewOption::GetPageBreakColor().getBColor();
|
|
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSeq =
|
|
lcl_CreateDashedIndicatorPrimitive( aStart, aEnd, aLineColor );
|
|
aSeq.realloc( aSeq.getLength( ) + 1 );
|
|
|
|
// Add the text above
|
|
rtl::OUString aBreakText = ResId::toString( SW_RES( STR_COLUMN_BREAK ) );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aFontSize;
|
|
OutputDevice* pOut = pGlobalShell->GetOut();
|
|
Font aFont = pOut->GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetToolFont();
|
|
aFont.SetHeight( 8 * 20 );
|
|
pOut->SetFont( aFont );
|
|
drawinglayer::attribute::FontAttribute aFontAttr = drawinglayer::primitive2d::getFontAttributeFromVclFont(
|
|
aFontSize, aFont, false, false );
|
|
|
|
Rectangle aTextRect;
|
|
pOut->GetTextBoundRect( aTextRect, String( aBreakText ) );
|
|
long nTextOff = ( nWidth - aTextRect.GetWidth() ) / 2;
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DHomMatrix aTextMatrix( basegfx::tools::createScaleTranslateB2DHomMatrix(
|
|
aFontSize.getX(), aFontSize.getY(),
|
|
aRect.Left() + nTextOff, aRect.Top() ) );
|
|
if ( IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
aTextMatrix = basegfx::B2DHomMatrix( basegfx::tools::createScaleShearXRotateTranslateB2DHomMatrix (
|
|
aFontSize.getX(), aFontSize.getY(), 0.0, M_PI_2,
|
|
aRect.Right(), aRect.Top() + nTextOff ) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::TextSimplePortionPrimitive2D * pText =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::TextSimplePortionPrimitive2D(
|
|
aTextMatrix,
|
|
aBreakText, 0, aBreakText.getLength(),
|
|
std::vector< double >(),
|
|
aFontAttr,
|
|
lang::Locale(),
|
|
aLineColor );
|
|
aSeq[ aSeq.getLength() - 1 ] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pText );
|
|
|
|
ProcessPrimitives( aSeq );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::PaintDecorators( ) const
|
|
{
|
|
SwWrtShell* pWrtSh = dynamic_cast< SwWrtShell* >( pGlobalShell );
|
|
if ( pWrtSh )
|
|
{
|
|
SwEditWin& rEditWin = pWrtSh->GetView().GetEditWin();
|
|
|
|
const SwLayoutFrm* pBody = FindBodyCont();
|
|
if ( pBody )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aBodyRect( pBody->Frm() );
|
|
|
|
if ( !pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPrinting() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsPDFExport() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->IsPreView() &&
|
|
pGlobalShell->IsShowHeaderFooterSeparator( ) )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::processor2d::BaseProcessor2D* pProcessor = CreateProcessor2D();
|
|
|
|
// Header
|
|
const SwFrm* pHeaderFrm = Lower();
|
|
if ( !pHeaderFrm->IsHeaderFrm() )
|
|
pHeaderFrm = NULL;
|
|
|
|
const SwRect& rVisArea = pGlobalShell->VisArea();
|
|
long nXOff = std::min( aBodyRect.Right(), rVisArea.Right() );
|
|
|
|
long nHeaderYOff = aBodyRect.Top();
|
|
Point nOutputOff = rEditWin.LogicToPixel( Point( nXOff, nHeaderYOff ) );
|
|
rEditWin.SetHeaderFooterControl( this, true, nOutputOff );
|
|
|
|
pProcessor->process( lcl_CreateHeaderFooterSeparatorPrimitives(
|
|
this, double( nHeaderYOff ) ) );
|
|
|
|
// Footer
|
|
const SwFrm* pFtnContFrm = Lower();
|
|
while ( pFtnContFrm->GetNext() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pFtnContFrm->IsFtnContFrm() )
|
|
aBodyRect.AddBottom( pFtnContFrm->Frm().Bottom() - aBodyRect.Bottom() );
|
|
pFtnContFrm = pFtnContFrm->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
long nFooterYOff = aBodyRect.Bottom();
|
|
nOutputOff = rEditWin.LogicToPixel( Point( nXOff, nFooterYOff ) );
|
|
rEditWin.SetHeaderFooterControl( this, false, nOutputOff );
|
|
|
|
pProcessor->process( lcl_CreateHeaderFooterSeparatorPrimitives(
|
|
this, double( nFooterYOff ) ) );
|
|
|
|
delete pProcessor;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** FlyFrm::IsBackgroundTransparent - for feature #99657#
|
|
|
|
OD 12.08.2002
|
|
determines, if background of fly frame has to be drawn transparent
|
|
declaration found in /core/inc/flyfrm.cxx
|
|
OD 08.10.2002 #103898# - If the background of the fly frame itself is not
|
|
transparent and the background is inherited from its parent/grandparent,
|
|
the background brush, used for drawing, has to be investigated for transparency.
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@return true, if background is transparent drawn.
|
|
*/
|
|
sal_Bool SwFlyFrm::IsBackgroundTransparent() const
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Bool bBackgroundTransparent = GetFmt()->IsBackgroundTransparent();
|
|
if ( !bBackgroundTransparent &&
|
|
static_cast<const SwFlyFrmFmt*>(GetFmt())->IsBackgroundBrushInherited() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBrushItem* pBackgrdBrush = 0;
|
|
const Color* pSectionTOXColor = 0;
|
|
SwRect aDummyRect;
|
|
if ( GetBackgroundBrush( pBackgrdBrush, pSectionTOXColor, aDummyRect, false) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pSectionTOXColor &&
|
|
(pSectionTOXColor->GetTransparency() != 0) &&
|
|
(pSectionTOXColor->GetColor() != COL_TRANSPARENT) )
|
|
{
|
|
bBackgroundTransparent = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( pBackgrdBrush )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( (pBackgrdBrush->GetColor().GetTransparency() != 0) &&
|
|
(pBackgrdBrush->GetColor() != COL_TRANSPARENT) )
|
|
{
|
|
bBackgroundTransparent = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const GraphicObject *pTmpGrf =
|
|
static_cast<const GraphicObject*>(pBackgrdBrush->GetGraphicObject());
|
|
if ( (pTmpGrf) &&
|
|
(pTmpGrf->GetAttr().GetTransparency() != 0)
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
bBackgroundTransparent = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return bBackgroundTransparent;
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/** FlyFrm::IsShadowTransparent - for feature #99657#
|
|
|
|
OD 13.08.2002
|
|
determine, if shadow color of fly frame has to be drawn transparent
|
|
declaration found in /core/inc/flyfrm.cxx
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@return true, if shadow color is transparent.
|
|
*/
|
|
sal_Bool SwFlyFrm::IsShadowTransparent() const
|
|
{
|
|
return GetFmt()->IsShadowTransparent();
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFlyFrm::IsPaint()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool SwFlyFrm::IsPaint( SdrObject *pObj, const ViewShell *pSh )
|
|
{
|
|
SdrObjUserCall *pUserCall;
|
|
|
|
if ( 0 == ( pUserCall = GetUserCall(pObj) ) )
|
|
return sal_True;
|
|
|
|
//Attributabhaengig nicht fuer Drucker oder PreView painten
|
|
sal_Bool bPaint = pFlyOnlyDraw ||
|
|
((SwContact*)pUserCall)->GetFmt()->GetPrint().GetValue();
|
|
if ( !bPaint )
|
|
bPaint = pSh->GetWin() && !pSh->IsPreView();
|
|
|
|
if ( bPaint )
|
|
{
|
|
//Das Paint kann evtl. von von uebergeordneten Flys verhindert werden.
|
|
SwFrm *pAnch = 0;
|
|
if ( pObj->ISA(SwVirtFlyDrawObj) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwFlyFrm *pFly = ((SwVirtFlyDrawObj*)pObj)->GetFlyFrm();
|
|
if ( pFlyOnlyDraw && pFlyOnlyDraw == pFly )
|
|
return sal_True;
|
|
|
|
//Die Anzeige eines Zwischenstadiums vermeiden, Flys die nicht mit
|
|
//der Seite auf der sie verankert sind ueberlappen werden auch
|
|
//nicht gepaintet.
|
|
//HACK: Ausnahme: Drucken von Rahmen in Tabellen, diese koennen
|
|
//bei uebergrossen Tabellen (HTML) schon mal auserhalb der Seite
|
|
//stehen.
|
|
SwPageFrm *pPage = pFly->FindPageFrm();
|
|
if ( pPage )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pPage->Frm().IsOver( pFly->Frm() ) )
|
|
pAnch = pFly->AnchorFrm();
|
|
else if ( bTableHack &&
|
|
pFly->Frm().Top() >= pFly->GetAnchorFrm()->Frm().Top() &&
|
|
pFly->Frm().Top() < pFly->GetAnchorFrm()->Frm().Bottom() &&
|
|
long(pSh->GetOut()) ==
|
|
long(pSh->getIDocumentDeviceAccess()->getPrinter( false ) ) )
|
|
{
|
|
pAnch = pFly->AnchorFrm();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 13.10.2003 #i19919# - consider 'virtual' drawing objects
|
|
// OD 2004-03-29 #i26791#
|
|
SwDrawContact* pDrawContact = dynamic_cast<SwDrawContact*>(pUserCall);
|
|
pAnch = pDrawContact ? pDrawContact->GetAnchorFrm(pObj) : NULL;
|
|
if ( pAnch )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pAnch->GetValidPosFlag() )
|
|
pAnch = 0;
|
|
else if ( long(pSh->GetOut()) == long(pSh->getIDocumentDeviceAccess()->getPrinter( false )))
|
|
{
|
|
//HACK: fuer das Drucken muessen wir ein paar Objekte
|
|
//weglassen, da diese sonst doppelt gedruckt werden.
|
|
//Die Objekte sollen gedruckt werden, wenn der TableHack
|
|
//gerade greift. In der Folge duerfen sie nicht gedruckt werden
|
|
//wenn sie mit der Seite dran sind, ueber der sie von der
|
|
//Position her gerade schweben.
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage = pAnch->FindPageFrm();
|
|
if ( !bTableHack &&
|
|
!pPage->Frm().IsOver( pObj->GetCurrentBoundRect() ) )
|
|
pAnch = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 02.07.2003 #108784# - debug assert
|
|
if ( !pObj->ISA(SdrObjGroup) )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_FAIL( "<SwFlyFrm::IsPaint(..)> - paint of drawing object without anchor frame!?" );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pAnch )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pAnch->IsInFly() )
|
|
bPaint = SwFlyFrm::IsPaint( pAnch->FindFlyFrm()->GetVirtDrawObj(),
|
|
pSh );
|
|
else if ( pFlyOnlyDraw )
|
|
bPaint = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bPaint = sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
return bPaint;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|* SwCellFrm::Paint( const SwRect& ) const
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
void SwCellFrm::Paint(SwRect const& rRect, SwPrintData const*const) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( GetLayoutRowSpan() >= 1 )
|
|
SwLayoutFrm::Paint( rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFlyFrm::Paint()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
//Weiter unten definiert
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_PaintLowerBorders( const SwLayoutFrm *pLay,
|
|
const SwRect &rRect, const SwPageFrm *pPage );
|
|
|
|
void SwFlyFrm::Paint(SwRect const& rRect, SwPrintData const*const) const
|
|
{
|
|
//wegen der Ueberlappung von Rahmen und Zeichenobjekten muessen die
|
|
//Flys ihre Umrandung (und die der Innenliegenden) direkt ausgeben.
|
|
//z.B. #33066#
|
|
pLines->LockLines(sal_True);
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
aRect._Intersection( Frm() );
|
|
|
|
OutputDevice* pOut = pGlobalShell->GetOut();
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_CLIPREGION );
|
|
pOut->SetClipRegion();
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
|
|
const SwNoTxtFrm *pNoTxt = Lower() && Lower()->IsNoTxtFrm()
|
|
? (SwNoTxtFrm*)Lower() : 0;
|
|
|
|
bool bIsChart = false; //#i102950# don't paint additional borders for charts
|
|
//check whether we have a chart
|
|
if(pNoTxt)
|
|
{
|
|
const SwNoTxtNode* pNoTNd = dynamic_cast<const SwNoTxtNode*>(pNoTxt->GetNode());
|
|
if( pNoTNd )
|
|
{
|
|
SwOLENode* pOLENd = const_cast<SwOLENode*>(pNoTNd->GetOLENode());
|
|
if( pOLENd && ChartPrettyPainter::IsChart( pOLENd->GetOLEObj().GetObject() ) )
|
|
bIsChart = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
bool bContour = GetFmt()->GetSurround().IsContour();
|
|
PolyPolygon aPoly;
|
|
if ( bContour )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 16.04.2003 #i13147# - add 2nd parameter with value <sal_True>
|
|
// to indicate that method is called for paint in order to avoid
|
|
// load of the intrinsic graphic.
|
|
bContour = GetContour( aPoly, sal_True );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// #i47804# - distinguish complete background paint
|
|
// and margin paint.
|
|
// paint complete background for Writer text fly frames
|
|
bool bPaintCompleteBack( !pNoTxt );
|
|
// paint complete background for transparent graphic and contour,
|
|
// if own background color exists.
|
|
const bool bIsGraphicTransparent = pNoTxt ? pNoTxt->IsTransparent() : false;
|
|
if ( !bPaintCompleteBack &&
|
|
( bIsGraphicTransparent|| bContour ) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBrushItem &rBack = GetFmt()->GetBackground();
|
|
// OD 07.08.2002 #99657# #GetTransChg#
|
|
// to determine, if background has to be painted, by checking, if
|
|
// background color is not COL_TRANSPARENT ("no fill"/"auto fill")
|
|
// or a background graphic exists.
|
|
bPaintCompleteBack = !(rBack.GetColor() == COL_TRANSPARENT) ||
|
|
rBack.GetGraphicPos() != GPOS_NONE;
|
|
}
|
|
// paint of margin needed.
|
|
const bool bPaintMarginOnly( !bPaintCompleteBack &&
|
|
Prt().SSize() != Frm().SSize() );
|
|
|
|
// #i47804# - paint background of parent fly frame
|
|
// for transparent graphics in layer Hell, if parent fly frame isn't
|
|
// in layer Hell. It's only painted the intersection between the
|
|
// parent fly frame area and the paint area <aRect>
|
|
const IDocumentDrawModelAccess* pIDDMA = GetFmt()->getIDocumentDrawModelAccess();
|
|
|
|
if ( bIsGraphicTransparent &&
|
|
GetVirtDrawObj()->GetLayer() == pIDDMA->GetHellId() &&
|
|
GetAnchorFrm()->FindFlyFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFlyFrm* pParentFlyFrm = GetAnchorFrm()->FindFlyFrm();
|
|
if ( pParentFlyFrm->GetDrawObj()->GetLayer() !=
|
|
pIDDMA->GetHellId() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwFlyFrm* pOldRet = pRetoucheFly2;
|
|
pRetoucheFly2 = const_cast<SwFlyFrm*>(this);
|
|
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), pParentFlyFrm );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect( aRect );
|
|
aPaintRect._Intersection( pParentFlyFrm->Frm() );
|
|
pParentFlyFrm->PaintBackground( aPaintRect, pPage, rAttrs, sal_False, sal_False );
|
|
|
|
pRetoucheFly2 = pOldRet;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bPaintCompleteBack || bPaintMarginOnly )
|
|
{
|
|
//#24926# JP 01.02.96, PaintBaBo in teilen hier, damit PaintBorder
|
|
//das orig. Rect bekommt, aber PaintBackground das begrenzte.
|
|
|
|
// OD 2004-04-23 #116347#
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_FILLCOLOR|PUSH_LINECOLOR );
|
|
pOut->SetLineColor();
|
|
|
|
pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)this );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
|
|
// paint background
|
|
{
|
|
SwRegionRects aRegion( aRect );
|
|
// #i80822#
|
|
// suppress painting of background in printing area for
|
|
// non-transparent graphics.
|
|
if ( bPaintMarginOnly ||
|
|
( pNoTxt && !bIsGraphicTransparent ) )
|
|
{
|
|
//Was wir eigentlich Painten wollen ist der schmale Streifen
|
|
//zwischen PrtArea und aeusserer Umrandung.
|
|
SwRect aTmp( Prt() ); aTmp += Frm().Pos();
|
|
aRegion -= aTmp;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bContour )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->Push();
|
|
// #i80822#
|
|
// apply clip region under the same conditions, which are
|
|
// used in <SwNoTxtFrm::Paint(..)> to set the clip region
|
|
// for painting the graphic/OLE. Thus, the clip region is
|
|
// also applied for the PDF export.
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
if ( !pOut->GetConnectMetaFile() || !pSh || !pSh->GetWin() )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->SetClipRegion( aPoly );
|
|
}
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
PaintBackground( aRegion[i], pPage, rAttrs, sal_False, sal_True );
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
PaintBackground( aRegion[i], pPage, rAttrs, sal_False, sal_True );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - paint border before painting background
|
|
// paint border
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aTmp( rRect );
|
|
PaintBorder( aTmp, pPage, rAttrs );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 19.12.2002 #106318# - fly frame will paint it's subsidiary lines and
|
|
// the subsidiary lines of its lowers on its own, due to overlapping with
|
|
// other fly frames or other objects.
|
|
if( pGlobalShell->GetWin()
|
|
&& !bIsChart ) //#i102950# don't paint additional borders for charts
|
|
{
|
|
bool bSubsLineRectsCreated;
|
|
if ( pSubsLines )
|
|
{
|
|
// Lock already existing subsidiary lines
|
|
pSubsLines->LockLines( sal_True );
|
|
bSubsLineRectsCreated = false;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// create new subsidiardy lines
|
|
pSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
bSubsLineRectsCreated = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool bSpecSubsLineRectsCreated;
|
|
if ( pSpecSubsLines )
|
|
{
|
|
// Lock already existing special subsidiary lines
|
|
pSpecSubsLines->LockLines( sal_True );
|
|
bSpecSubsLineRectsCreated = false;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// create new special subsidiardy lines
|
|
pSpecSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
bSpecSubsLineRectsCreated = true;
|
|
}
|
|
// Add subsidiary lines of fly frame and its lowers
|
|
RefreshLaySubsidiary( pPage, aRect );
|
|
// paint subsidiary lines of fly frame and its lowers
|
|
pSpecSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pOut, NULL );
|
|
pSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pOut, pLines );
|
|
if ( !bSubsLineRectsCreated )
|
|
// unlock subsidiary lines
|
|
pSubsLines->LockLines( sal_False );
|
|
else
|
|
// delete created subsidiary lines container
|
|
DELETEZ( pSubsLines );
|
|
|
|
if ( !bSpecSubsLineRectsCreated )
|
|
// unlock special subsidiary lines
|
|
pSpecSubsLines->LockLines( sal_False );
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// delete created special subsidiary lines container
|
|
DELETEZ( pSpecSubsLines );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwLayoutFrm::Paint( aRect );
|
|
|
|
Validate();
|
|
|
|
// OD 19.12.2002 #106318# - first paint lines added by fly frame paint
|
|
// and then unlock other lines.
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( pOut );
|
|
pLines->LockLines( sal_False );
|
|
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
|
|
if ( pProgress && pNoTxt )
|
|
pProgress->Reschedule();
|
|
}
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwTabFrm::Paint()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwTabFrm::Paint(SwRect const& rRect, SwPrintData const*const) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsTable() )
|
|
{
|
|
// #i29550#
|
|
if ( IsCollapsingBorders() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)this );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
|
|
// paint shadow
|
|
if ( rAttrs.GetShadow().GetLocation() != SVX_SHADOW_NONE )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect;
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( aRect, this, rAttrs, sal_True );
|
|
PaintShadow( rRect, aRect, rAttrs );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// paint lines
|
|
SwTabFrmPainter aHelper( *this );
|
|
aHelper.PaintLines( *pGlobalShell->GetOut(), rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
// <-- collapsing
|
|
|
|
SwLayoutFrm::Paint( rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
// OD 10.01.2003 #i6467# - no light grey rectangle for page preview
|
|
else if ( pGlobalShell->GetWin() && !pGlobalShell->IsPreView() )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 10.01.2003 #i6467# - intersect output rectangle with table frame
|
|
SwRect aTabRect( Prt() );
|
|
aTabRect.Pos() += Frm().Pos();
|
|
SwRect aTabOutRect( rRect );
|
|
aTabOutRect.Intersection( aTabRect );
|
|
pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->
|
|
DrawRect( pGlobalShell->GetOut(), aTabOutRect, COL_LIGHTGRAY );
|
|
}
|
|
((SwTabFrm*)this)->ResetComplete();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintShadow()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Malt einen Schatten wenns das FrmFormat fordert.
|
|
|* Der Schatten wird immer an den auesseren Rand des OutRect gemalt.
|
|
|* Das OutRect wird ggf. so verkleinert, dass auf diesem das
|
|
|* malen der Umrandung stattfinden kann.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
/// OD 23.08.2002 #99657#
|
|
/// draw full shadow rectangle for frames with transparent drawn backgrounds.
|
|
void SwFrm::PaintShadow( const SwRect& rRect, SwRect& rOutRect,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxShadowItem &rShadow = rAttrs.GetShadow();
|
|
const long nWidth = ::lcl_AlignWidth ( rShadow.GetWidth() );
|
|
const long nHeight = ::lcl_AlignHeight( rShadow.GetWidth() );
|
|
|
|
SwRects aRegion( 2, 2 );
|
|
SwRect aOut( rOutRect );
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bCnt = IsCntntFrm();
|
|
const sal_Bool bTop = !bCnt || rAttrs.GetTopLine ( *(this) ) ? sal_True : sal_False;
|
|
const sal_Bool bBottom = !bCnt || rAttrs.GetBottomLine( *(this) ) ? sal_True : sal_False;
|
|
|
|
SvxShadowLocation eLoc = rShadow.GetLocation();
|
|
|
|
SWRECTFN( this )
|
|
if( IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
switch( eLoc )
|
|
{
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMRIGHT: eLoc = SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMLEFT; break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_TOPLEFT: eLoc = SVX_SHADOW_TOPRIGHT; break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_TOPRIGHT: eLoc = SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMRIGHT; break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMLEFT: eLoc = SVX_SHADOW_TOPLEFT; break;
|
|
default: break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// OD 23.08.2002 #99657# - determine, if full shadow rectangle have to
|
|
/// be drawn or only two shadow rectangles beside the frame.
|
|
/// draw full shadow rectangle, if frame background is drawn transparent.
|
|
/// Status Quo:
|
|
/// SwLayoutFrm can have transparent drawn backgrounds. Thus,
|
|
/// "asked" their frame format.
|
|
sal_Bool bDrawFullShadowRectangle =
|
|
( IsLayoutFrm() &&
|
|
(static_cast<const SwLayoutFrm*>(this))->GetFmt()->IsBackgroundTransparent()
|
|
);
|
|
switch ( eLoc )
|
|
{
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMRIGHT:
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bDrawFullShadowRectangle )
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - draw full shadow rectangle
|
|
aOut.Top( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Left( aOut.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aOut.Top ( aOut.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Left( aOut.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
aOut.Left( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
aOut.Top ( rOutRect.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
if ( bCnt && (!bTop || !bBottom) )
|
|
::lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( aOut, *(this), rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
rOutRect.Right ( rOutRect.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
rOutRect.Bottom( rOutRect.Bottom()- nHeight );
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_TOPLEFT:
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bDrawFullShadowRectangle )
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - draw full shadow rectangle
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Right( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Right ( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
aOut.Right ( aOut.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
aOut.Bottom( rOutRect.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
aOut.Top( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
if ( bCnt && (!bBottom || !bTop) )
|
|
::lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( aOut, *(this), rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
rOutRect.Left( rOutRect.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
rOutRect.Top( rOutRect.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_TOPRIGHT:
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bDrawFullShadowRectangle )
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - draw full shadow rectangle
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Bottom() - nHeight);
|
|
aOut.Left( aOut.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Left ( aOut.Left()+ nWidth );
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
aOut.Left ( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
aOut.Bottom( rOutRect.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
if ( bTop )
|
|
aOut.Top( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
if ( bCnt && (!bBottom || bTop) )
|
|
::lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( aOut, *(this), rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
rOutRect.Right( rOutRect.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
rOutRect.Top( rOutRect.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case SVX_SHADOW_BOTTOMLEFT:
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bDrawFullShadowRectangle )
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - draw full shadow rectangle
|
|
aOut.Top( aOut.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Right( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
aOut.Top ( aOut.Bottom()- nHeight );
|
|
aOut.Right( aOut.Right() - nWidth );
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
aOut.Right( aOut.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
aOut.Top( rOutRect.Top() + nHeight );
|
|
if ( bBottom )
|
|
aOut.Bottom( aOut.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
if ( bCnt && (!bTop || !bBottom) )
|
|
::lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( aOut, *(this), rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
aRegion.Insert( aOut, aRegion.Count() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
rOutRect.Left( rOutRect.Left() + nWidth );
|
|
rOutRect.Bottom( rOutRect.Bottom() - nHeight );
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( !this, "new ShadowLocation() ?" );
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
OutputDevice *pOut = pGlobalShell->GetOut();
|
|
|
|
sal_uLong nOldDrawMode = pOut->GetDrawMode();
|
|
Color aShadowColor( rShadow.GetColor() );
|
|
if( aRegion.Count() && pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
// Is heigh contrast mode, the output device has already set the
|
|
// DRAWMODE_SETTINGSFILL flag. This causes the SetFillColor function
|
|
// to ignore the setting of a new color. Therefore we have to reset
|
|
// the drawing mode
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( 0 );
|
|
aShadowColor = SwViewOption::GetFontColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( pOut->GetFillColor() != aShadowColor )
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor( aShadowColor );
|
|
|
|
pOut->SetDrawMode( nOldDrawMode );
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect &rOut = aRegion[i];
|
|
aOut = rOut;
|
|
// OD 30.09.2002 #103636# - no SwAlign of shadow rectangle
|
|
// no alignment necessary, because (1) <rRect> is already aligned
|
|
// and because (2) paint of border and background will occur later.
|
|
// Thus, (1) assures that no conflicts with neighbour object will occure
|
|
// and (2) assures that border and background is not affected by the
|
|
// shadow paint.
|
|
/*
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aOut, pGlobalShell );
|
|
*/
|
|
if ( rRect.IsOver( aOut ) && aOut.Height() > 0 && aOut.Width() > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
aOut._Intersection( rRect );
|
|
pOut->DrawRect( aOut.SVRect() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintBorderLine()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwFrm::PaintBorderLine( const SwRect& rRect,
|
|
const SwRect& rOutRect,
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const Color *pColor,
|
|
const SvxBorderStyle nStyle ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !rOutRect.IsOver( rRect ) )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
SwRect aOut( rOutRect );
|
|
aOut._Intersection( rRect );
|
|
|
|
const SwTabFrm *pTab = IsCellFrm() ? FindTabFrm() : 0;
|
|
sal_uInt8 nSubCol = ( IsCellFrm() || IsRowFrm() ) ? SUBCOL_TAB :
|
|
( IsInSct() ? SUBCOL_SECT :
|
|
( IsInFly() ? SUBCOL_FLY : SUBCOL_PAGE ) );
|
|
if( pColor && pGlobalShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
pColor = &SwViewOption::GetFontColor();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( pPage->GetSortedObjs() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRegionRects aRegion( aOut, 4, 1 );
|
|
::lcl_SubtractFlys( this, pPage, aOut, aRegion );
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
pLines->AddLineRect( aRegion[i], pColor, nStyle, pTab, nSubCol );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
pLines->AddLineRect( aOut, pColor, nStyle, pTab, nSubCol );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintBorderLines()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Nur alle Linien einfach oder alle Linien doppelt!!!!
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
// OD 29.04.2003 #107169# - method called for left and right border rectangles.
|
|
// For a printer output device perform adjustment for non-overlapping top and
|
|
// bottom border rectangles. Thus, add parameter <_bPrtOutputDev> to indicate
|
|
// printer output device.
|
|
// NOTE: For printer output device left/right border rectangle <_iorRect>
|
|
// has to be already non-overlapping the outer top/bottom border rectangle.
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_SubTopBottom( SwRect& _iorRect,
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& _rBox,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& _rAttrs,
|
|
const SwFrm& _rFrm,
|
|
const SwRectFn& _rRectFn,
|
|
const sal_Bool _bPrtOutputDev )
|
|
{
|
|
const sal_Bool bCnt = _rFrm.IsCntntFrm();
|
|
if ( _rBox.GetTop() && _rBox.GetTop()->GetInWidth() &&
|
|
( !bCnt || _rAttrs.GetTopLine( _rFrm ) )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
// substract distance between outer and inner line.
|
|
SwTwips nDist = ::lcl_MinHeightDist( _rBox.GetTop()->GetDistance() );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - non-overlapping border rectangles:
|
|
// adjust x-/y-position, if inner top line is a hair line (width = 1)
|
|
sal_Bool bIsInnerTopLineHairline = sal_False;
|
|
if ( !_bPrtOutputDev )
|
|
{
|
|
// additionally substract width of top outer line
|
|
// --> left/right inner/outer line doesn't overlap top outer line.
|
|
nDist += ::lcl_AlignHeight( _rBox.GetTop()->GetOutWidth() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 29.04.2003 #107169# - additionally substract width of top inner line
|
|
// --> left/right inner/outer line doesn't overlap top inner line.
|
|
nDist += ::lcl_AlignHeight( _rBox.GetTop()->GetInWidth() );
|
|
bIsInnerTopLineHairline = _rBox.GetTop()->GetInWidth() == 1;
|
|
}
|
|
(_iorRect.*_rRectFn->fnSubTop)( -nDist );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - adjust calculated border top, if inner top line
|
|
// is a hair line
|
|
if ( bIsInnerTopLineHairline )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _rFrm.IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
// right of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( _iorRect.Right(), 0 );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X() + 1, aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_True, -1 );
|
|
_iorRect.Right( aCompPt.X() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// top of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( 0, _iorRect.Top() );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X(), aCompPt.Y() - 1 );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_False, +1 );
|
|
_iorRect.Top( aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( _rBox.GetBottom() && _rBox.GetBottom()->GetInWidth() &&
|
|
( !bCnt || _rAttrs.GetBottomLine( _rFrm ) )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
// substract distance between outer and inner line.
|
|
SwTwips nDist = ::lcl_MinHeightDist( _rBox.GetBottom()->GetDistance() );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - non-overlapping border rectangles:
|
|
// adjust x-/y-position, if inner bottom line is a hair line (width = 1)
|
|
sal_Bool bIsInnerBottomLineHairline = sal_False;
|
|
if ( !_bPrtOutputDev )
|
|
{
|
|
// additionally substract width of bottom outer line
|
|
// --> left/right inner/outer line doesn't overlap bottom outer line.
|
|
nDist += ::lcl_AlignHeight( _rBox.GetBottom()->GetOutWidth() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 29.04.2003 #107169# - additionally substract width of bottom inner line
|
|
// --> left/right inner/outer line doesn't overlap bottom inner line.
|
|
nDist += ::lcl_AlignHeight( _rBox.GetBottom()->GetInWidth() );
|
|
bIsInnerBottomLineHairline = _rBox.GetBottom()->GetInWidth() == 1;
|
|
}
|
|
(_iorRect.*_rRectFn->fnAddBottom)( -nDist );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - adjust calculated border bottom, if inner
|
|
// bottom line is a hair line.
|
|
if ( bIsInnerBottomLineHairline )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _rFrm.IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
// left of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( _iorRect.Left(), 0 );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X() - 1, aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_True, +1 );
|
|
_iorRect.Left( aCompPt.X() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// bottom of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( 0, _iorRect.Bottom() );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X(), aCompPt.Y() + 1 );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_False, -1 );
|
|
_iorRect.Bottom( aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sal_uInt16 lcl_GetLineWidth( const SvxBorderLine* pLine )
|
|
{
|
|
sal_uInt16 result = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ( pLine != NULL )
|
|
result = pLine->GetScaledWidth();
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
double lcl_GetExtent( const SvxBorderLine* pSideLine, const SvxBorderLine* pOppositeLine )
|
|
{
|
|
double nExtent = 0.0;
|
|
|
|
if ( pSideLine && !pSideLine->isEmpty() )
|
|
nExtent = -lcl_GetLineWidth( pSideLine ) / 2.0;
|
|
else if ( pOppositeLine )
|
|
nExtent = lcl_GetLineWidth( pOppositeLine ) / 2.0;
|
|
|
|
return nExtent;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - merge <lcl_PaintLeftLine> and <lcl_PaintRightLine>
|
|
// into new method <lcl_PaintLeftRightLine(..)>
|
|
void lcl_PaintLeftRightLine( const sal_Bool _bLeft,
|
|
const SwFrm& _rFrm,
|
|
const SwPageFrm& /*_rPage*/,
|
|
const SwRect& _rOutRect,
|
|
const SwRect& /*_rRect*/,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& _rAttrs,
|
|
const SwRectFn& _rRectFn )
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& rBox = _rAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
const sal_Bool bR2L = _rFrm.IsCellFrm() && _rFrm.IsRightToLeft();
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pLeftRightBorder = 0;
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pTopBorder = rBox.GetTop();
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pBottomBorder = rBox.GetBottom();
|
|
|
|
if ( _bLeft )
|
|
{
|
|
pLeftRightBorder = bR2L ? rBox.GetRight() : rBox.GetLeft();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
pLeftRightBorder = bR2L ? rBox.GetLeft() : rBox.GetRight();
|
|
}
|
|
// OD 06.05.2003 #107169# - init boolean indicating printer output device.
|
|
const sal_Bool bPrtOutputDev =
|
|
( OUTDEV_PRINTER == pGlobalShell->GetOut()->GetOutDevType() );
|
|
|
|
if ( !pLeftRightBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRect( _rOutRect );
|
|
if ( _bLeft )
|
|
{
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnAddRight)( ::lcl_AlignWidth( lcl_GetLineWidth( pLeftRightBorder ) ) -
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnGetWidth)() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnSubLeft)( ::lcl_AlignWidth( lcl_GetLineWidth( pLeftRightBorder ) ) -
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnGetWidth)() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const sal_Bool bCnt = _rFrm.IsCntntFrm();
|
|
|
|
if ( bCnt )
|
|
{
|
|
::lcl_ExtendLeftAndRight( aRect, _rFrm, _rAttrs, _rRectFn );
|
|
|
|
// No Top / bottom borders for joint borders
|
|
if ( _rAttrs.JoinedWithPrev( _rFrm ) ) pTopBorder = NULL;
|
|
if ( _rAttrs.JoinedWithNext( _rFrm ) ) pBottomBorder = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 06.05.2003 #107169# - adjustments for printer output device
|
|
if ( bPrtOutputDev )
|
|
{
|
|
// substract width of outer top line.
|
|
if ( rBox.GetTop() && (!bCnt || _rAttrs.GetTopLine( _rFrm )) )
|
|
{
|
|
long nDist = ::lcl_AlignHeight( rBox.GetTop()->GetOutWidth() );
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnSubTop)( -nDist );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - If outer top line is hair line, calculated
|
|
// top has to be adjusted.
|
|
if ( nDist == 1 )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _rFrm.IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
// right of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( aRect.Right(), 0 );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X() + 1, aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_True, -1 );
|
|
aRect.Right( aCompPt.X() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// top of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( 0, aRect.Top() );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X(), aCompPt.Y() - 1 );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_False, +1 );
|
|
aRect.Top( aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// substract width of outer bottom line.
|
|
if ( rBox.GetBottom() && (!bCnt || _rAttrs.GetBottomLine( _rFrm )) )
|
|
{
|
|
long nDist = ::lcl_AlignHeight( rBox.GetBottom()->GetOutWidth());
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnAddBottom)( -nDist );
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - If outer bottom line is hair line, calculated
|
|
// top has to be adjusted.
|
|
if ( nDist == 1 )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _rFrm.IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
// left of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( aRect.Left(), 0 );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X() - 1, aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_True, +1 );
|
|
aRect.Left( aCompPt.X() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// bottom of border rectangle has to be checked and adjusted
|
|
Point aCompPt( 0, aRect.Bottom() );
|
|
Point aRefPt( aCompPt.X(), aCompPt.Y() + 1 );
|
|
lcl_CompPxPosAndAdjustPos( *(pGlobalShell->GetOut()),
|
|
aRefPt, aCompPt,
|
|
sal_False, -1 );
|
|
aRect.Bottom( aCompPt.Y() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !pLeftRightBorder->GetInWidth() )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 06.05.2003 #107169# - add 6th parameter
|
|
::lcl_SubTopBottom( aRect, rBox, _rAttrs, _rFrm, _rRectFn, bPrtOutputDev );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// TODO Postpone the processing of the primitives
|
|
if ( lcl_GetLineWidth( pLeftRightBorder ) > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSequence( 1 );
|
|
|
|
double nExtentIS = lcl_GetExtent( pTopBorder, NULL );
|
|
double nExtentIE = lcl_GetExtent( pBottomBorder, NULL );
|
|
double nExtentOS = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pTopBorder );
|
|
double nExtentOE = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pBottomBorder );
|
|
|
|
if ( !_bLeft )
|
|
{
|
|
nExtentIS = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pTopBorder );
|
|
nExtentIE = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pBottomBorder );
|
|
nExtentOS = lcl_GetExtent( pTopBorder, NULL );
|
|
nExtentOE = lcl_GetExtent( pBottomBorder, NULL );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aStart( aRect.Left() + aRect.Width() / 2.0, aRect.Top() + lcl_GetLineWidth( pTopBorder ) / 2.0 );
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aEnd( aRect.Left() + aRect.Width() / 2.0, aRect.Bottom() - lcl_GetLineWidth( pBottomBorder ) / 2.0 );
|
|
|
|
double nLeftWidth = !_bLeft ? pLeftRightBorder->GetOutWidth() : pLeftRightBorder->GetInWidth( );
|
|
double nRightWidth = !_bLeft ? pLeftRightBorder->GetInWidth() : pLeftRightBorder->GetOutWidth( );
|
|
Color aLeftColor = _bLeft ? pLeftRightBorder->GetColorOut( _bLeft ) : pLeftRightBorder->GetColorIn( _bLeft );
|
|
Color aRightColor = _bLeft ? pLeftRightBorder->GetColorIn( _bLeft ) : pLeftRightBorder->GetColorOut( _bLeft );
|
|
|
|
aSequence[0] = new drawinglayer::primitive2d::BorderLinePrimitive2D(
|
|
aStart, aEnd, nLeftWidth, pLeftRightBorder->GetDistance(), nRightWidth,
|
|
nExtentIS, nExtentIE, nExtentOS, nExtentOE,
|
|
aLeftColor.getBColor(), aRightColor.getBColor(),
|
|
pLeftRightBorder->GetColorGap().getBColor(),
|
|
pLeftRightBorder->HasGapColor(), pLeftRightBorder->GetStyle( ) );
|
|
|
|
_rFrm.ProcessPrimitives( aSequence );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 19.05.2003 #109667# - merge <lcl_PaintTopLine> and <lcl_PaintBottomLine>
|
|
// into <lcl_PaintTopLine>
|
|
void lcl_PaintTopBottomLine( const sal_Bool _bTop,
|
|
const SwFrm& _rFrm,
|
|
const SwPageFrm& /*_rPage*/,
|
|
const SwRect& _rOutRect,
|
|
const SwRect& /*_rRect*/,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& _rAttrs,
|
|
const SwRectFn& _rRectFn )
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& rBox = _rAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pTopBottomBorder = 0;
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pLeftBorder = rBox.GetLeft();
|
|
const SvxBorderLine* pRightBorder = rBox.GetRight();
|
|
if ( _bTop )
|
|
{
|
|
pTopBottomBorder = rBox.GetTop();
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
pTopBottomBorder = rBox.GetBottom();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !pTopBottomBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRect( _rOutRect );
|
|
if ( _bTop )
|
|
{
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnAddBottom)( ::lcl_AlignHeight( lcl_GetLineWidth( pTopBottomBorder ) ) -
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnGetHeight)() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnSubTop)( ::lcl_AlignHeight( lcl_GetLineWidth( pTopBottomBorder ) ) -
|
|
(aRect.*_rRectFn->fnGetHeight)() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// TODO Postpone the processing of the primitives
|
|
if ( lcl_GetLineWidth( pTopBottomBorder ) > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSequence( 1 );
|
|
|
|
double nExtentIS = lcl_GetExtent( pRightBorder, NULL );
|
|
double nExtentIE = lcl_GetExtent( pLeftBorder, NULL );
|
|
double nExtentOS = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pRightBorder );
|
|
double nExtentOE = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pLeftBorder );
|
|
|
|
if ( !_bTop )
|
|
{
|
|
nExtentIS = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pRightBorder );
|
|
nExtentIE = lcl_GetExtent( NULL, pLeftBorder );
|
|
nExtentOS = lcl_GetExtent( pRightBorder, NULL );
|
|
nExtentOE = lcl_GetExtent( pLeftBorder, NULL );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aStart( aRect.Right() - lcl_GetLineWidth( pRightBorder ) / 2.0, aRect.Top() + aRect.Height() / 2.0 );
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aEnd( aRect.Left() + lcl_GetLineWidth( pLeftBorder ) / 2.0, aRect.Top() + aRect.Height() / 2.0 );
|
|
|
|
double nLeftWidth = !_bTop ? pTopBottomBorder->GetOutWidth() : pTopBottomBorder->GetInWidth( );
|
|
double nRightWidth = !_bTop ? pTopBottomBorder->GetInWidth() : pTopBottomBorder->GetOutWidth( );
|
|
Color aLeftColor = _bTop ? pTopBottomBorder->GetColorOut( _bTop ) : pTopBottomBorder->GetColorIn( _bTop );
|
|
Color aRightColor = _bTop ? pTopBottomBorder->GetColorIn( _bTop ) : pTopBottomBorder->GetColorOut( _bTop );
|
|
|
|
aSequence[0] = new drawinglayer::primitive2d::BorderLinePrimitive2D(
|
|
aStart, aEnd, nLeftWidth, pTopBottomBorder->GetDistance(), nRightWidth,
|
|
nExtentIS, nExtentIE, nExtentOS, nExtentOE,
|
|
aLeftColor.getBColor(), aRightColor.getBColor(),
|
|
pTopBottomBorder->GetColorGap().getBColor(),
|
|
pTopBottomBorder->HasGapColor(), pTopBottomBorder->GetStyle( ) );
|
|
|
|
_rFrm.ProcessPrimitives( aSequence );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* const SwFrm* lcl_HasNextCell( const SwFrm& rFrm )
|
|
|*
|
|
|* No comment. #i15844#
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm* lcl_HasNextCell( const SwFrm& rFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( rFrm.IsCellFrm(),
|
|
"lcl_HasNextCell( const SwFrm& rFrm ) should be called with SwCellFrm" );
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm* pTmpFrm = &rFrm;
|
|
do
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pTmpFrm->GetNext() )
|
|
return pTmpFrm->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
pTmpFrm = pTmpFrm->GetUpper()->GetUpper();
|
|
}
|
|
while ( pTmpFrm->IsCellFrm() );
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintBorder()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Malt Schatten und Umrandung
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
/** local method to determine cell frame, from which the border attributes
|
|
for paint of top/bottom border has to be used.
|
|
|
|
OD 21.02.2003 #b4779636#, #107692#
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@param _pCellFrm
|
|
input parameter - constant pointer to cell frame for which the cell frame
|
|
for the border attributes has to be determined.
|
|
|
|
@param _rCellBorderAttrs
|
|
input parameter - constant reference to the border attributes of cell frame
|
|
<_pCellFrm>.
|
|
|
|
@param _bTop
|
|
input parameter - boolean, that controls, if cell frame for top border or
|
|
for bottom border has to be determined.
|
|
|
|
@return constant pointer to cell frame, for which the border attributes has
|
|
to be used
|
|
*/
|
|
const SwFrm* lcl_GetCellFrmForBorderAttrs( const SwFrm* _pCellFrm,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs& _rCellBorderAttrs,
|
|
const bool _bTop )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( _pCellFrm, "No cell frame available, dying soon" );
|
|
|
|
// determine, if cell frame is at bottom/top border of a table frame and
|
|
// the table frame has/is a follow.
|
|
const SwFrm* pTmpFrm = _pCellFrm;
|
|
bool bCellAtBorder = true;
|
|
bool bCellAtLeftBorder = !_pCellFrm->GetPrev();
|
|
bool bCellAtRightBorder = !_pCellFrm->GetNext();
|
|
while( !pTmpFrm->IsRowFrm() || !pTmpFrm->GetUpper()->IsTabFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
pTmpFrm = pTmpFrm->GetUpper();
|
|
if ( pTmpFrm->IsRowFrm() &&
|
|
(_bTop ? pTmpFrm->GetPrev() : pTmpFrm->GetNext())
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
bCellAtBorder = false;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pTmpFrm->IsCellFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pTmpFrm->GetPrev() )
|
|
{
|
|
bCellAtLeftBorder = false;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pTmpFrm->GetNext() )
|
|
{
|
|
bCellAtRightBorder = false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( pTmpFrm && pTmpFrm->IsRowFrm(), "No RowFrm available" );
|
|
|
|
const SwLayoutFrm* pParentRowFrm = static_cast<const SwLayoutFrm*>(pTmpFrm);
|
|
const SwTabFrm* pParentTabFrm =
|
|
static_cast<const SwTabFrm*>(pParentRowFrm->GetUpper());
|
|
|
|
const bool bCellNeedsAttribute = bCellAtBorder &&
|
|
( _bTop ?
|
|
// bCellInFirstRowWithMaster
|
|
( !pParentRowFrm->GetPrev() &&
|
|
pParentTabFrm->IsFollow() &&
|
|
0 == pParentTabFrm->GetTable()->GetRowsToRepeat() ) :
|
|
// bCellInLastRowWithFollow
|
|
( !pParentRowFrm->GetNext() &&
|
|
pParentTabFrm->GetFollow() )
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm* pRet = _pCellFrm;
|
|
if ( bCellNeedsAttribute )
|
|
{
|
|
// determine, if cell frame has no borders inside the table.
|
|
const SwFrm* pNextCell = 0;
|
|
bool bNoBordersInside = false;
|
|
|
|
if ( bCellAtLeftBorder && ( 0 != ( pNextCell = lcl_HasNextCell( *_pCellFrm ) ) ) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), pNextCell );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rBorderAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& rBorderBox = rBorderAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
bCellAtRightBorder = !lcl_HasNextCell( *pNextCell );
|
|
bNoBordersInside =
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetTop() || !pParentRowFrm->GetPrev() ) &&
|
|
!rBorderBox.GetLeft() &&
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetRight() || bCellAtRightBorder ) &&
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetBottom() || !pParentRowFrm->GetNext() );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBoxItem& rBorderBox = _rCellBorderAttrs.GetBox();
|
|
bNoBordersInside =
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetTop() || !pParentRowFrm->GetPrev() ) &&
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetLeft() || bCellAtLeftBorder ) &&
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetRight() || bCellAtRightBorder ) &&
|
|
( !rBorderBox.GetBottom() || !pParentRowFrm->GetNext() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bNoBordersInside )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _bTop && !_rCellBorderAttrs.GetBox().GetTop() )
|
|
{
|
|
//-hack
|
|
// Cell frame has no top border and no border inside the table, but
|
|
// it is at the top border of a table frame, which is a follow.
|
|
// Thus, use border attributes of cell frame in first row of complete table.
|
|
// First, determine first table frame of complete table.
|
|
SwTabFrm* pMasterTabFrm = pParentTabFrm->FindMaster( true );
|
|
// determine first row of complete table.
|
|
const SwFrm* pFirstRow = pMasterTabFrm->GetLower();
|
|
// return first cell in first row
|
|
SwFrm* pLowerCell = const_cast<SwFrm*>(pFirstRow->GetLower());
|
|
while ( !pLowerCell->IsCellFrm() ||
|
|
( pLowerCell->GetLower() && pLowerCell->GetLower()->IsRowFrm() )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
pLowerCell = pLowerCell->GetLower();
|
|
}
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( pLowerCell && pLowerCell->IsCellFrm(), "No CellFrm available" );
|
|
pRet = pLowerCell;
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( !_bTop && !_rCellBorderAttrs.GetBox().GetBottom() )
|
|
{
|
|
//-hack
|
|
// Cell frame has no bottom border and no border inside the table,
|
|
// but it is at the bottom border of a table frame, which has a follow.
|
|
// Thus, use border attributes of cell frame in last row of complete table.
|
|
// First, determine last table frame of complete table.
|
|
SwTabFrm* pLastTabFrm = const_cast<SwTabFrm*>(pParentTabFrm->GetFollow());
|
|
while ( pLastTabFrm->GetFollow() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLastTabFrm = pLastTabFrm->GetFollow();
|
|
}
|
|
// determine last row of complete table.
|
|
SwFrm* pLastRow = pLastTabFrm->GetLastLower();
|
|
// return first bottom border cell in last row
|
|
SwFrm* pLowerCell = const_cast<SwFrm*>(pLastRow->GetLower());
|
|
while ( !pLowerCell->IsCellFrm() ||
|
|
( pLowerCell->GetLower() && pLowerCell->GetLower()->IsRowFrm() )
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pLowerCell->IsRowFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
while ( pLowerCell->GetNext() )
|
|
{
|
|
pLowerCell = pLowerCell->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
pLowerCell = pLowerCell->GetLower();
|
|
}
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( pLowerCell && pLowerCell->IsCellFrm(), "No CellFrm available" );
|
|
pRet = pLowerCell;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return pRet;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::processor2d::BaseProcessor2D * SwFrm::CreateProcessor2D( ) const
|
|
{
|
|
basegfx::B2DRange aViewRange;
|
|
|
|
SdrPage *pDrawPage = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell()->Imp()->GetPageView()->GetPage();
|
|
const drawinglayer::geometry::ViewInformation2D aNewViewInfos(
|
|
basegfx::B2DHomMatrix( ),
|
|
getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell()->GetOut()->GetViewTransformation(),
|
|
aViewRange,
|
|
GetXDrawPageForSdrPage( pDrawPage ),
|
|
0.0,
|
|
uno::Sequence< beans::PropertyValue >() );
|
|
|
|
return sdr::contact::createBaseProcessor2DFromOutputDevice(
|
|
*getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell()->GetOut(),
|
|
aNewViewInfos );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwFrm::ProcessPrimitives( const drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence& rSequence ) const
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::processor2d::BaseProcessor2D * pProcessor2D = CreateProcessor2D();
|
|
|
|
if ( pProcessor2D )
|
|
{
|
|
pProcessor2D->process( rSequence );
|
|
delete pProcessor2D;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwFrm::PaintBorder( const SwRect& rRect, const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs ) const
|
|
{
|
|
//fuer (Row,Body,Ftn,Root,Column,NoTxt) gibt's hier nix zu tun
|
|
if ( (GetType() & 0x90C5) )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if ( (GetType() & 0x2000) && //Cell
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsTable() )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
// #i29550#
|
|
if ( IsTabFrm() || IsCellFrm() || IsRowFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwTabFrm* pTabFrm = FindTabFrm();
|
|
if ( pTabFrm->IsCollapsingBorders() )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
if ( pTabFrm->GetTable()->IsNewModel() && ( !IsCellFrm() || IsCoveredCell() ) )
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const bool bLine = rAttrs.IsLine() ? true : false;
|
|
const bool bShadow = rAttrs.GetShadow().GetLocation() != SVX_SHADOW_NONE;
|
|
|
|
// - flag to control,
|
|
//-hack has to be used.
|
|
const bool bb4779636HackActive = true;
|
|
//
|
|
const SwFrm* pCellFrmForBottomBorderAttrs = 0;
|
|
const SwFrm* pCellFrmForTopBorderAttrs = 0;
|
|
bool bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs = false;
|
|
if ( bb4779636HackActive && IsCellFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
pCellFrmForBottomBorderAttrs = lcl_GetCellFrmForBorderAttrs( this, rAttrs, false );
|
|
if ( pCellFrmForBottomBorderAttrs != this )
|
|
bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs = true;
|
|
pCellFrmForTopBorderAttrs = lcl_GetCellFrmForBorderAttrs( this, rAttrs, true );
|
|
if ( pCellFrmForTopBorderAttrs != this )
|
|
bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// - add condition <bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs>
|
|
//-hack
|
|
if ( bLine || bShadow || bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs )
|
|
{
|
|
//Wenn das Rechteck vollstandig innerhalb der PrtArea liegt,
|
|
//so braucht kein Rand gepainted werden.
|
|
//Fuer die PrtArea muss der Aligned'e Wert zugrunde gelegt werden,
|
|
//anderfalls wuerden u.U. Teile nicht verarbeitet.
|
|
SwRect aRect( Prt() );
|
|
aRect += Frm().Pos();
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
// OD 27.09.2002 #103636# - new local boolean variable in order to
|
|
// suspend border paint under special cases - see below.
|
|
// NOTE: This is a fix for the implementation of feature #99657#.
|
|
bool bDrawOnlyShadowForTransparentFrame = false;
|
|
if ( aRect.IsInside( rRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 27.09.2002 #103636# - paint shadow, if background is transparent.
|
|
// Because of introduced transparent background for fly frame #99657#,
|
|
// the shadow have to be drawn if the background is transparent,
|
|
// in spite the fact that the paint rectangle <rRect> lies fully
|
|
// in the printing area.
|
|
// NOTE to chosen solution:
|
|
// On transparent background, continue processing, but suspend
|
|
// drawing of border by setting <bDrawOnlyShadowForTransparentFrame>
|
|
// to true.
|
|
if ( IsLayoutFrm() &&
|
|
static_cast<const SwLayoutFrm*>(this)->GetFmt()->IsBackgroundTransparent() )
|
|
{
|
|
bDrawOnlyShadowForTransparentFrame = true;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( !pPage )
|
|
pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( aRect, this, rAttrs, sal_True );
|
|
rAttrs.SetGetCacheLine( sal_True );
|
|
if ( bShadow )
|
|
PaintShadow( rRect, aRect, rAttrs );
|
|
// OD 27.09.2002 #103636# - suspend drawing of border
|
|
// add condition < NOT bDrawOnlyShadowForTransparentFrame > - see above
|
|
// - add condition <bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs>
|
|
//-hack.
|
|
if ( ( bLine || bFoundCellForTopOrBorderAttrs ) &&
|
|
!bDrawOnlyShadowForTransparentFrame )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pDirRefFrm = IsCellFrm() ? FindTabFrm() : this;
|
|
SWRECTFN( pDirRefFrm )
|
|
::lcl_PaintLeftRightLine ( sal_True, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
::lcl_PaintLeftRightLine ( sal_False, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
if ( !IsCntntFrm() || rAttrs.GetTopLine( *(this) ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// -
|
|
//-hack
|
|
// paint is found, paint its top border.
|
|
if ( IsCellFrm() && pCellFrmForTopBorderAttrs != this )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(),
|
|
pCellFrmForTopBorderAttrs );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rTopAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
::lcl_PaintTopBottomLine( sal_True, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rTopAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
::lcl_PaintTopBottomLine( sal_True, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rAttrs, fnRect );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( !IsCntntFrm() || rAttrs.GetBottomLine( *(this) ) )
|
|
{
|
|
// -
|
|
//-hack
|
|
// paint is found, paint its bottom border.
|
|
if ( IsCellFrm() && pCellFrmForBottomBorderAttrs != this )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(),
|
|
pCellFrmForBottomBorderAttrs );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rBottomAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
::lcl_PaintTopBottomLine(sal_False, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rBottomAttrs, fnRect);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
::lcl_PaintTopBottomLine(sal_False, *(this), *(pPage), aRect, rRect, rAttrs, fnRect);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
rAttrs.SetGetCacheLine( sal_False );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFtnContFrm::PaintBorder()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Spezialimplementierung wg. der Fussnotenlinie.
|
|
|* Derzeit braucht nur der obere Rand beruecksichtigt werden.
|
|
|* Auf andere Linien und Schatten wird verzichtet.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwFtnContFrm::PaintBorder( const SwRect& rRect, const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
//Wenn das Rechteck vollstandig innerhalb der PrtArea liegt, so gibt es
|
|
//keinen Rand zu painten.
|
|
SwRect aRect( Prt() );
|
|
aRect.Pos() += Frm().Pos();
|
|
if ( !aRect.IsInside( rRect ) )
|
|
PaintLine( rRect, pPage );
|
|
}
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFtnContFrm::PaintLine()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Fussnotenline malen.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwFtnContFrm::PaintLine( const SwRect& rRect,
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage ) const
|
|
{
|
|
//Laenge der Linie ergibt sich aus der prozentualen Angabe am PageDesc.
|
|
//Die Position ist ebenfalls am PageDesc angegeben.
|
|
//Der Pen steht direkt im PageDesc.
|
|
|
|
if ( !pPage )
|
|
pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
const SwPageFtnInfo &rInf = pPage->GetPageDesc()->GetFtnInfo();
|
|
|
|
SWRECTFN( this )
|
|
SwTwips nPrtWidth = (Prt().*fnRect->fnGetWidth)();
|
|
Fraction aFract( nPrtWidth, 1 );
|
|
const SwTwips nWidth = (long)(aFract *= rInf.GetWidth());
|
|
|
|
SwTwips nX = (this->*fnRect->fnGetPrtLeft)();
|
|
switch ( rInf.GetAdj() )
|
|
{
|
|
case FTNADJ_CENTER:
|
|
nX += nPrtWidth/2 - nWidth/2; break;
|
|
case FTNADJ_RIGHT:
|
|
nX += nPrtWidth - nWidth; break;
|
|
case FTNADJ_LEFT:
|
|
/* do nothing */; break;
|
|
default:
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( !this, "Neues Adjustment fuer Fussnotenlinie?" );
|
|
}
|
|
SwTwips nLineWidth = rInf.GetLineWidth();
|
|
const SwRect aLineRect = bVert ?
|
|
SwRect( Point(Frm().Left()+Frm().Width()-rInf.GetTopDist()-nLineWidth,
|
|
nX), Size( nLineWidth, nWidth ) )
|
|
: SwRect( Point( nX, Frm().Pos().Y() + rInf.GetTopDist() ),
|
|
Size( nWidth, rInf.GetLineWidth()));
|
|
if ( aLineRect.HasArea() )
|
|
PaintBorderLine( rRect, aLineRect , pPage, &rInf.GetLineColor(),
|
|
rInf.GetLineStyle() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwLayoutFrm::PaintColLines()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Painted die Trennlinien fuer die innenliegenden
|
|
|* Spalten.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwLayoutFrm::PaintColLines( const SwRect &rRect, const SwFmtCol &rFmtCol,
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm *pCol = Lower();
|
|
if ( !pCol || !pCol->IsColumnFrm() )
|
|
return;
|
|
//Badaa: 2008-04-18 * Support for Classical Mongolian Script (SCMS) joint with Jiayanmin
|
|
SwRectFn fnRect = pCol->IsVertical() ? ( pCol->IsVertLR() ? fnRectVertL2R : fnRectVert ) : fnRectHori;
|
|
|
|
SwRect aLineRect = Prt();
|
|
aLineRect += Frm().Pos();
|
|
|
|
SwTwips nTop = ((aLineRect.*fnRect->fnGetHeight)()*rFmtCol.GetLineHeight())
|
|
/ 100 - (aLineRect.*fnRect->fnGetHeight)();
|
|
SwTwips nBottom = 0;
|
|
|
|
switch ( rFmtCol.GetLineAdj() )
|
|
{
|
|
case COLADJ_CENTER:
|
|
nBottom = nTop / 2; nTop -= nBottom; break;
|
|
case COLADJ_TOP:
|
|
nBottom = nTop; nTop = 0; break;
|
|
case COLADJ_BOTTOM:
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( !this, "Neues Adjustment fuer Spaltenlinie?" );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if( nTop )
|
|
(aLineRect.*fnRect->fnSubTop)( nTop );
|
|
if( nBottom )
|
|
(aLineRect.*fnRect->fnAddBottom)( nBottom );
|
|
|
|
SwTwips nPenHalf = rFmtCol.GetLineWidth();
|
|
(aLineRect.*fnRect->fnSetWidth)( nPenHalf );
|
|
nPenHalf /= 2;
|
|
|
|
//Damit uns nichts verlorengeht muessen wir hier etwas grosszuegiger sein.
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
(aRect.*fnRect->fnSubLeft)( nPenHalf + nPixelSzW );
|
|
(aRect.*fnRect->fnAddRight)( nPenHalf + nPixelSzW );
|
|
SwRectGet fnGetX = IsRightToLeft() ? fnRect->fnGetLeft : fnRect->fnGetRight;
|
|
while ( pCol->GetNext() )
|
|
{
|
|
(aLineRect.*fnRect->fnSetPosX)
|
|
( (pCol->Frm().*fnGetX)() - nPenHalf );
|
|
if ( aRect.IsOver( aLineRect ) )
|
|
PaintBorderLine( aRect, aLineRect , pPage, &rFmtCol.GetLineColor(),
|
|
rFmtCol.GetLineStyle() );
|
|
pCol = pCol->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::PaintGrid( OutputDevice* pOut, SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if( !bHasGrid || pRetoucheFly || pRetoucheFly2 )
|
|
return;
|
|
GETGRID( this )
|
|
if( pGrid && ( OUTDEV_PRINTER != pOut->GetOutDevType() ?
|
|
pGrid->GetDisplayGrid() : pGrid->GetPrintGrid() ) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLayoutFrm* pBody = FindBodyCont();
|
|
if( pBody )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aGrid( pBody->Prt() );
|
|
aGrid += pBody->Frm().Pos();
|
|
|
|
SwRect aInter( aGrid );
|
|
aInter.Intersection( rRect );
|
|
if( aInter.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Bool bGrid = pGrid->GetRubyTextBelow();
|
|
sal_Bool bCell = GRID_LINES_CHARS == pGrid->GetGridType();
|
|
long nGrid = pGrid->GetBaseHeight();
|
|
const SwDoc* pDoc = GetFmt()->GetDoc();
|
|
long nGridWidth = GETGRIDWIDTH(pGrid,pDoc); //for textgrid refactor
|
|
long nRuby = pGrid->GetRubyHeight();
|
|
long nSum = nGrid + nRuby;
|
|
const Color *pCol = &pGrid->GetColor();
|
|
|
|
SwTwips nRight = aInter.Left() + aInter.Width();
|
|
SwTwips nBottom = aInter.Top() + aInter.Height();
|
|
if( IsVertical() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nOrig = aGrid.Left() + aGrid.Width();
|
|
SwTwips nY = nOrig + nSum *
|
|
( ( nOrig - aInter.Left() ) / nSum );
|
|
SwRect aTmp( Point( nY, aInter.Top() ),
|
|
Size( 1, aInter.Height() ) );
|
|
SwTwips nX = aGrid.Top() + nGrid *
|
|
( ( aInter.Top() - aGrid.Top() )/ nGrid );
|
|
if( nX < aInter.Top() )
|
|
nX += nGrid;
|
|
SwTwips nGridBottom = aGrid.Top() + aGrid.Height();
|
|
sal_Bool bLeft = aGrid.Top() >= aInter.Top();
|
|
sal_Bool bRight = nGridBottom <= nBottom;
|
|
sal_Bool bBorder = bLeft || bRight;
|
|
while( nY > nRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aTmp.Pos().X() = nY;
|
|
if( bGrid )
|
|
{
|
|
nY -= nGrid;
|
|
SwTwips nPosY = Max( aInter.Left(), nY );
|
|
SwTwips nHeight = Min(nRight, aTmp.Pos().X())-nPosY;
|
|
if( nHeight > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bCell )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nPosY, nX ),
|
|
Size( nHeight, 1 ) );
|
|
while( aVert.Top() <= nBottom )
|
|
{
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() += nGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nPosY, aGrid.Top() ),
|
|
Size( nHeight, 1 ) );
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() = nGridBottom;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nY -= nRuby;
|
|
if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nPos = Max( aInter.Left(), nY );
|
|
SwTwips nW = Min(nRight, aTmp.Pos().X()) - nPos;
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nPos, aGrid.Top() ),
|
|
Size( nW, 1 ) );
|
|
if( nW > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() = nGridBottom;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bGrid = !bGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
while( nY >= aInter.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
aTmp.Pos().X() = nY;
|
|
PaintBorderLine( rRect, aTmp, this, pCol);
|
|
if( bGrid )
|
|
{
|
|
nY -= nGrid;
|
|
SwTwips nHeight = aTmp.Pos().X()
|
|
- Max(aInter.Left(), nY );
|
|
if( nHeight > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bCell )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point(aTmp.Pos().X()-nHeight,
|
|
nX ), Size( nHeight, 1 ) );
|
|
while( aVert.Top() <= nBottom )
|
|
{
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() += nGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point(aTmp.Pos().X()-nHeight,
|
|
aGrid.Top() ), Size( nHeight, 1 ) );
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() = nGridBottom;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nY -= nRuby;
|
|
if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nPos = Max( aInter.Left(), nY );
|
|
SwTwips nW = Min(nRight, aTmp.Pos().X()) - nPos;
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nPos, aGrid.Top() ),
|
|
Size( nW, 1 ) );
|
|
if( nW > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().Y() = nGridBottom;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bGrid = !bGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nOrig = aGrid.Top();
|
|
SwTwips nY = nOrig + nSum *( (aInter.Top()-nOrig)/nSum );
|
|
SwRect aTmp( Point( aInter.Left(), nY ),
|
|
Size( aInter.Width(), 1 ) );
|
|
//for textgrid refactor
|
|
SwTwips nX = aGrid.Left() + nGridWidth *
|
|
( ( aInter.Left() - aGrid.Left() )/ nGridWidth );
|
|
if( nX < aInter.Left() )
|
|
nX += nGridWidth;
|
|
SwTwips nGridRight = aGrid.Left() + aGrid.Width();
|
|
sal_Bool bLeft = aGrid.Left() >= aInter.Left();
|
|
sal_Bool bRight = nGridRight <= nRight;
|
|
sal_Bool bBorder = bLeft || bRight;
|
|
while( nY < aInter.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
aTmp.Pos().Y() = nY;
|
|
if( bGrid )
|
|
{
|
|
nY += nGrid;
|
|
SwTwips nPosY = Max( aInter.Top(), aTmp.Pos().Y() );
|
|
SwTwips nHeight = Min(nBottom, nY ) - nPosY;
|
|
if( nHeight )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bCell )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nX, nPosY ),
|
|
Size( 1, nHeight ) );
|
|
while( aVert.Left() <= nRight )
|
|
{
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() += nGridWidth; //for textgrid refactor
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if ( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( aGrid.Left(), nPosY ),
|
|
Size( 1, nHeight ) );
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() = nGridRight;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nY += nRuby;
|
|
if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nPos = Max(aInter.Top(),aTmp.Pos().Y());
|
|
SwTwips nH = Min( nBottom, nY ) - nPos;
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( aGrid.Left(), nPos ),
|
|
Size( 1, nH ) );
|
|
if( nH > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() = nGridRight;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bGrid = !bGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
while( nY <= nBottom )
|
|
{
|
|
aTmp.Pos().Y() = nY;
|
|
PaintBorderLine( rRect, aTmp, this, pCol);
|
|
if( bGrid )
|
|
{
|
|
nY += nGrid;
|
|
SwTwips nHeight = Min(nBottom, nY) - aTmp.Pos().Y();
|
|
if( nHeight )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bCell )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( nX, aTmp.Pos().Y() ),
|
|
Size( 1, nHeight ) );
|
|
while( aVert.Left() <= nRight )
|
|
{
|
|
PaintBorderLine( rRect, aVert, this, pCol);
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() += nGridWidth; //for textgrid refactor
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( aGrid.Left(),
|
|
aTmp.Pos().Y() ), Size( 1, nHeight ) );
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() = nGridRight;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
nY += nRuby;
|
|
if( bBorder )
|
|
{
|
|
SwTwips nPos = Max(aInter.Top(),aTmp.Pos().Y());
|
|
SwTwips nH = Min( nBottom, nY ) - nPos;
|
|
SwRect aVert( Point( aGrid.Left(), nPos ),
|
|
Size( 1, nH ) );
|
|
if( nH > 0 )
|
|
{
|
|
if( bLeft )
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
if( bRight )
|
|
{
|
|
aVert.Pos().X() = nGridRight;
|
|
PaintBorderLine(rRect,aVert,this,pCol);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
bGrid = !bGrid;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** paint margin area of a page
|
|
|
|
OD 20.11.2002 for #104598#:
|
|
implement paint of margin area; margin area will be painted for a
|
|
view shell with a window and if the document is not in online layout.
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@param _rOutputRect
|
|
input parameter - constant instance reference of the rectangle, for
|
|
which an output has to be generated.
|
|
|
|
@param _pViewShell
|
|
input parameter - instance of the view shell, on which the output
|
|
has to be generated.
|
|
*/
|
|
void SwPageFrm::PaintMarginArea( const SwRect& _rOutputRect,
|
|
ViewShell* _pViewShell ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( _pViewShell->GetWin() &&
|
|
!_pViewShell->GetViewOptions()->getBrowseMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aPgPrtRect( Prt() );
|
|
aPgPrtRect.Pos() += Frm().Pos();
|
|
if ( !aPgPrtRect.IsInside( _rOutputRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aPgRect = Frm();
|
|
aPgRect._Intersection( _rOutputRect );
|
|
if(aPgRect.Height() < 0 || aPgRect.Width() <= 0) // No intersection
|
|
return;
|
|
SwRegionRects aPgRegion( aPgRect );
|
|
aPgRegion -= aPgPrtRect;
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pPage = static_cast<const SwPageFrm*>(this);
|
|
if ( pPage->GetSortedObjs() )
|
|
::lcl_SubtractFlys( this, pPage, aPgRect, aPgRegion );
|
|
if ( aPgRegion.Count() )
|
|
{
|
|
OutputDevice *pOut = _pViewShell->GetOut();
|
|
if ( pOut->GetFillColor() != aGlobalRetoucheColor )
|
|
pOut->SetFillColor( aGlobalRetoucheColor );
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aPgRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( 1 < aPgRegion.Count() )
|
|
{
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aPgRegion[i], pGlobalShell );
|
|
if( !aPgRegion[i].HasArea() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
pOut->DrawRect(aPgRegion[i].SVRect());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const sal_Int8 SwPageFrm::mnShadowPxWidth = 9;
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool SwPageFrm::IsRightShadowNeeded() const
|
|
{
|
|
const ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
const bool bIsLTR = getRootFrm()->IsLeftToRightViewLayout();
|
|
|
|
// We paint the right shadow if we're not in book mode
|
|
// or if we've no sibling or are the last page of the "row"
|
|
return !pSh || (!pSh->GetViewOptions()->IsViewLayoutBookMode()) || !GetNext()
|
|
|| (this == Lower()) || (bIsLTR && OnRightPage())
|
|
|| (!bIsLTR && !OnRightPage());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool SwPageFrm::IsLeftShadowNeeded() const
|
|
{
|
|
const ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
const bool bIsLTR = getRootFrm()->IsLeftToRightViewLayout();
|
|
|
|
// We paint the left shadow if we're not in book mode
|
|
// or if we've no sibling or are the last page of the "row"
|
|
return !pSh || (!pSh->GetViewOptions()->IsViewLayoutBookMode()) || !GetPrev()
|
|
|| (bIsLTR && !OnRightPage())
|
|
|| (!bIsLTR && OnRightPage());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** determine rectangle for bottom page shadow
|
|
|
|
OD 12.02.2003 for #i9719# and #105645#
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::GetHorizontalShadowRect( const SwRect& _rPageRect,
|
|
const ViewShell* _pViewShell,
|
|
SwRect& _orHorizontalShadowRect,
|
|
bool bPaintLeftShadow,
|
|
bool bPaintRightShadow,
|
|
bool bRightSidebar )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwPostItMgr *pMgr = _pViewShell ? _pViewShell->GetPostItMgr() : 0;
|
|
SwRect aAlignedPageRect( _rPageRect );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aAlignedPageRect, _pViewShell );
|
|
SwRect aPagePxRect =
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->LogicToPixel( aAlignedPageRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
long lShadowAdjustment = mnShadowPxWidth - 1; // TODO extract this
|
|
|
|
_orHorizontalShadowRect.Chg(
|
|
Point( aPagePxRect.Left() + (bPaintLeftShadow ? lShadowAdjustment : 0), 0 ),
|
|
Size( aPagePxRect.Width() - ( (bPaintLeftShadow ? lShadowAdjustment : 0) + (bPaintRightShadow ? lShadowAdjustment : 0) ),
|
|
mnShadowPxWidth ) );
|
|
|
|
if(pMgr && pMgr->ShowNotes() && pMgr->HasNotes())
|
|
{
|
|
// Notes are displayed, we've to extend borders
|
|
SwTwips aSidebarTotalWidth = pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(true) + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(true);
|
|
if(bRightSidebar)
|
|
_orHorizontalShadowRect.Right( _orHorizontalShadowRect.Right() + aSidebarTotalWidth );
|
|
else
|
|
_orHorizontalShadowRect.Left( _orHorizontalShadowRect.Left() - aSidebarTotalWidth );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** paint page border and shadow
|
|
|
|
OD 12.02.2003 for #i9719# and #105645#
|
|
implement paint of page border and shadow
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::PaintBorderAndShadow( const SwRect& _rPageRect,
|
|
const ViewShell* _pViewShell,
|
|
bool bPaintLeftShadow,
|
|
bool bPaintRightShadow,
|
|
bool bRightSidebar )
|
|
{
|
|
// No shadow in prefs
|
|
if( !SwViewOption::IsShadow() ) return;
|
|
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *_pViewShell->GetOut() );
|
|
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< drawinglayer::primitive2d::DiscreteShadow > shadowMaskObj
|
|
( new drawinglayer::primitive2d::DiscreteShadow( SW_RES( BMP_PAGE_SHADOW_MASK ) ));
|
|
static drawinglayer::primitive2d::DiscreteShadow& shadowMask = *shadowMaskObj.get();
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageTopRightShadowObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageBottomRightShadowObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageBottomLeftShadowObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageBottomShadowBaseObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageRightShadowBaseObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageTopShadowBaseObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageTopLeftShadowObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static vcl::DeleteOnDeinit< BitmapEx > aPageLeftShadowBaseObj( new BitmapEx );
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageTopRightShadow = *aPageTopRightShadowObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageBottomRightShadow = *aPageBottomRightShadowObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageBottomLeftShadow = *aPageBottomLeftShadowObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageBottomShadowBase = *aPageBottomShadowBaseObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageRightShadowBase = *aPageRightShadowBaseObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageTopShadowBase = *aPageTopShadowBaseObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageTopLeftShadow = *aPageTopLeftShadowObj.get();
|
|
static BitmapEx& aPageLeftShadowBase = *aPageLeftShadowBaseObj.get();
|
|
static Color aShadowColor( COL_AUTO );
|
|
|
|
SwRect aAlignedPageRect( _rPageRect );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aAlignedPageRect, _pViewShell );
|
|
SwRect aPagePxRect =
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->LogicToPixel( aAlignedPageRect.SVRect() );
|
|
|
|
|
|
if(aShadowColor != SwViewOption::GetShadowColor() ) {
|
|
aShadowColor = SwViewOption::GetShadowColor();
|
|
|
|
AlphaMask aMask( shadowMask.getBottomRight().GetBitmap() );
|
|
Bitmap aFilledSquare( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageBottomRightShadow = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getBottomLeft().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageBottomLeftShadow = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getBottom().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageBottomShadowBase = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getTop().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageTopShadowBase = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getTopRight().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageTopRightShadow = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getRight().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageRightShadowBase = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getTopLeft().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageTopLeftShadow = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
|
|
aMask = AlphaMask( shadowMask.getLeft().GetBitmap() );
|
|
aFilledSquare = Bitmap( aMask.GetSizePixel(), 24 );
|
|
aFilledSquare.Erase( aShadowColor );
|
|
aPageLeftShadowBase = BitmapEx( aFilledSquare, aMask );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect;
|
|
OutputDevice *pOut = _pViewShell->GetOut();
|
|
|
|
SwPageFrm::GetHorizontalShadowRect( _rPageRect, _pViewShell, aPaintRect, bPaintLeftShadow, bPaintRightShadow, bRightSidebar );
|
|
|
|
// Right shadow & corners
|
|
if ( bPaintRightShadow )
|
|
{
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( aPaintRect.Right() + 1, aPagePxRect.Bottom() + 1 - (aPageBottomRightShadow.GetSizePixel().Height() - mnShadowPxWidth) ) ),
|
|
aPageBottomRightShadow );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( aPaintRect.Right() + 1, aPagePxRect.Top() - mnShadowPxWidth ) ),
|
|
aPageTopRightShadow );
|
|
BitmapEx aPageRightShadow = aPageRightShadowBase;
|
|
aPageRightShadow.Scale( 1, aPagePxRect.Height() - 2 * (mnShadowPxWidth - 1) );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( aPaintRect.Right() + mnShadowPxWidth, aPagePxRect.Top() + mnShadowPxWidth - 1) ), aPageRightShadow );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Left shadows and corners
|
|
if(bPaintLeftShadow)
|
|
{
|
|
const long lLeft = aPaintRect.Left() - aPageBottomLeftShadow.GetSizePixel().Width();
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( lLeft,
|
|
aPagePxRect.Bottom() + 1 + mnShadowPxWidth - aPageBottomLeftShadow.GetSizePixel().Height() ) ), aPageBottomLeftShadow );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( lLeft, aPagePxRect.Top() - mnShadowPxWidth ) ), aPageTopLeftShadow );
|
|
BitmapEx aPageLeftShadow = aPageLeftShadowBase;
|
|
aPageLeftShadow.Scale( 1, aPagePxRect.Height() - 2 * (mnShadowPxWidth - 1) );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( lLeft, aPagePxRect.Top() + mnShadowPxWidth - 1) ), aPageLeftShadow );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BitmapEx aPageBottomShadow = aPageBottomShadowBase;
|
|
aPageBottomShadow.Scale( aPaintRect.Width(), 1 );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( aPaintRect.Left(), aPagePxRect.Bottom() + 1 ) ), aPageBottomShadow);
|
|
BitmapEx aPageTopShadow = aPageTopShadowBase;
|
|
aPageTopShadow.Scale( aPaintRect.Width(), 1 );
|
|
pOut->DrawBitmapEx( pOut->PixelToLogic( Point( aPaintRect.Left(), aPagePxRect.Top() - mnShadowPxWidth ) ), aPageTopShadow );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//mod #i6193# paint sidebar for notes
|
|
//IMPORTANT: if you change the rects here, also change SwPostItMgr::ScrollbarHit
|
|
/*static*/void SwPageFrm::PaintNotesSidebar(const SwRect& _rPageRect, ViewShell* _pViewShell, sal_uInt16 nPageNum, bool bRight)
|
|
{
|
|
//TOOD: cut out scrollbar area and arrows out of sidepane rect, otherwise it could flicker when pressing arrow buttons
|
|
if (!_pViewShell )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
SwRect aPageRect( _rPageRect );
|
|
SwAlignRect( aPageRect, _pViewShell );
|
|
|
|
const SwPostItMgr *pMgr = _pViewShell->GetPostItMgr();
|
|
if (pMgr && pMgr->ShowNotes() && pMgr->HasNotes()) // do not show anything in print preview
|
|
{
|
|
sal_Int32 nScrollerHeight = pMgr->GetSidebarScrollerHeight();
|
|
const Rectangle &aVisRect = _pViewShell->VisArea().SVRect();
|
|
//draw border and sidepane
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor();
|
|
if (!bRight)
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_BORDER);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(Rectangle(Point(aPageRect.Left()-pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(),aPageRect.Top()),Size(pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(),aPageRect.Height()))) ;
|
|
if (Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
else
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(Rectangle(Point(aPageRect.Left()-pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()-pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(),aPageRect.Top()),Size(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(),aPageRect.Height()))) ;
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_BORDER);
|
|
SwRect aSidebarBorder(aPageRect.TopRight(),Size(pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(),aPageRect.Height()));
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(aSidebarBorder.SVRect());
|
|
if (Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
else
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE);
|
|
SwRect aSidebar(Point(aPageRect.Right()+pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(),aPageRect.Top()),Size(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(),aPageRect.Height()));
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(aSidebar.SVRect());
|
|
}
|
|
if (pMgr->ShowScrollbar(nPageNum))
|
|
{
|
|
// draw scrollbar area and arrows
|
|
Point aPointBottom;
|
|
Point aPointTop;
|
|
aPointBottom = !bRight ? Point(aPageRect.Left() - pMgr->GetSidebarWidth() - pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(2,0)).Width(),aPageRect.Bottom()- _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,2+pMgr->GetSidebarScrollerHeight())).Height()) :
|
|
Point(aPageRect.Right() + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(2,0)).Width(),aPageRect.Bottom()- _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,2+pMgr->GetSidebarScrollerHeight())).Height());
|
|
aPointTop = !bRight ? Point(aPageRect.Left() - pMgr->GetSidebarWidth() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(2,0)).Width(),aPageRect.Top() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,2)).Height()) :
|
|
Point(aPageRect.Right() + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(2,0)).Width(),aPageRect.Top() + _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,2)).Height());
|
|
Size aSize(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth() - _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(4,0)).Width(), _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()) ;
|
|
Rectangle aRectBottom(aPointBottom,aSize);
|
|
Rectangle aRectTop(aPointTop,aSize);
|
|
|
|
if (aRectBottom.IsOver(aVisRect))
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor(COL_WHITE);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_SCROLLAREA);
|
|
}
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(aRectBottom);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawLine(aPointBottom + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3,0), aPointBottom + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3 , _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()));
|
|
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor();
|
|
Point aMiddleFirst(aPointBottom + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/6,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()/2));
|
|
Point aMiddleSecond(aPointBottom + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3*2,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()/2));
|
|
PaintNotesSidebarArrows(aMiddleFirst,aMiddleSecond,_pViewShell,pMgr->GetArrowColor(KEY_PAGEUP,nPageNum), pMgr->GetArrowColor(KEY_PAGEDOWN,nPageNum));
|
|
}
|
|
if (aRectTop.IsOver(aVisRect))
|
|
{
|
|
if (Application::GetSettings().GetStyleSettings().GetHighContrastMode() )
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor(COL_WHITE);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor(COL_BLACK);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(COL_NOTES_SIDEPANE_SCROLLAREA);
|
|
}
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawRect(aRectTop);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawLine(aPointTop + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3*2,0), aPointTop + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3*2 , _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()));
|
|
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetLineColor();
|
|
Point aMiddleFirst(aPointTop + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/3,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()/2));
|
|
Point aMiddleSecond(aPointTop + Point(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth()/6*5,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,nScrollerHeight)).Height()/2));
|
|
PaintNotesSidebarArrows(aMiddleFirst,aMiddleSecond,_pViewShell, pMgr->GetArrowColor(KEY_PAGEUP,nPageNum), pMgr->GetArrowColor(KEY_PAGEDOWN,nPageNum));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::PaintNotesSidebarArrows(const Point &aMiddleFirst, const Point &aMiddleSecond, ViewShell* _pViewShell, const Color aColorUp, const Color aColorDown)
|
|
{
|
|
Polygon aTriangleUp(3);
|
|
Polygon aTriangleDown(3);
|
|
|
|
aTriangleUp.SetPoint(aMiddleFirst + Point(0,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,-3)).Height()),0);
|
|
aTriangleUp.SetPoint(aMiddleFirst + Point(_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(-3,0)).Width(),_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,3)).Height()),1);
|
|
aTriangleUp.SetPoint(aMiddleFirst + Point(_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(3,0)).Width(),_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,3)).Height()),2);
|
|
|
|
aTriangleDown.SetPoint(aMiddleSecond + Point(_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(-3,0)).Width(),_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,-3)).Height()),0);
|
|
aTriangleDown.SetPoint(aMiddleSecond + Point(_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(+3,0)).Width(),_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,-3)).Height()),1);
|
|
aTriangleDown.SetPoint(aMiddleSecond + Point(0,_pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic(Size(0,3)).Height()),2);
|
|
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(aColorUp);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawPolygon(aTriangleUp);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->SetFillColor(aColorDown);
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->DrawPolygon(aTriangleDown);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** get bound rectangle of border and shadow for repaints
|
|
|
|
OD 12.02.2003 for #i9719# and #105645#
|
|
|
|
author OD
|
|
*/
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::GetBorderAndShadowBoundRect( const SwRect& _rPageRect,
|
|
const ViewShell* _pViewShell,
|
|
SwRect& _orBorderAndShadowBoundRect,
|
|
bool bLeftShadow,
|
|
bool bRightShadow,
|
|
bool bRightSidebar
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aAlignedPageRect( _rPageRect );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aAlignedPageRect, _pViewShell );
|
|
SwRect aPagePxRect =
|
|
_pViewShell->GetOut()->LogicToPixel( aAlignedPageRect.SVRect() );
|
|
aPagePxRect.Bottom( aPagePxRect.Bottom() + mnShadowPxWidth + 1 );
|
|
aPagePxRect.Top( aPagePxRect.Top() - mnShadowPxWidth - 1 );
|
|
|
|
SwRect aTmpRect;
|
|
|
|
// Always ask for full shadow since we want a bounding rect
|
|
// including at least the page frame
|
|
SwPageFrm::GetHorizontalShadowRect( _rPageRect, _pViewShell, aTmpRect, false, false, bRightSidebar );
|
|
|
|
if(bLeftShadow) aPagePxRect.Left( aTmpRect.Left() - mnShadowPxWidth - 1);
|
|
if(bRightShadow) aPagePxRect.Right( aTmpRect.Right() + mnShadowPxWidth + 1);
|
|
|
|
_orBorderAndShadowBoundRect = _pViewShell->GetOut()->PixelToLogic( aPagePxRect.SVRect() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect SwPageFrm::GetBoundRect() const
|
|
{
|
|
const ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
SwRect aPageRect( Frm() );
|
|
SwRect aResult;
|
|
|
|
if(!pSh) {
|
|
return SwRect( Point(0, 0), Size(0, 0) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwPageFrm::GetBorderAndShadowBoundRect( aPageRect, pSh, aResult,
|
|
IsLeftShadowNeeded(), IsRightShadowNeeded(), SidebarPosition() == sw::sidebarwindows::SIDEBAR_RIGHT );
|
|
return aResult;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::AddSidebarBorders(SwRect &aRect, ViewShell* _pViewShell, bool bRightSidebar, bool bPx)
|
|
{
|
|
const SwPostItMgr *pMgr = _pViewShell ? _pViewShell->GetPostItMgr() : 0;
|
|
if (pMgr && pMgr->ShowNotes() && pMgr->HasNotes())
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bRightSidebar)
|
|
aRect.SetLeftAndWidth(aRect.Left() - pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(bPx) - pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(bPx), aRect.Width() + pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(bPx) + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(bPx));
|
|
else
|
|
aRect.AddRight(pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(bPx) + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(bPx));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*static*/ void SwPageFrm::AddSidebarBorders(Rectangle &aRect, ViewShell* _pViewShell, bool bRightSidebar, bool bPx)
|
|
{
|
|
const SwPostItMgr *pMgr = _pViewShell ? _pViewShell->GetPostItMgr() : 0;
|
|
if (pMgr && pMgr->ShowNotes() && pMgr->HasNotes())
|
|
{
|
|
if (!bRightSidebar)
|
|
aRect.Left() -= (pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(bPx) + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(bPx));
|
|
else
|
|
aRect.Right() += pMgr->GetSidebarWidth(bPx) + pMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth(bPx);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*static*/ SwTwips SwPageFrm::GetSidebarBorderWidth( const ViewShell* _pViewShell )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwPostItMgr* pPostItMgr = _pViewShell ? _pViewShell->GetPostItMgr() : 0;
|
|
const SwTwips nRet = pPostItMgr && pPostItMgr->HasNotes() && pPostItMgr->ShowNotes() ? pPostItMgr->GetSidebarWidth() + pPostItMgr->GetSidebarBorderWidth() : 0;
|
|
return nRet;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintBaBo()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwFrm::PaintBaBo( const SwRect& rRect, const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const sal_Bool bLowerBorder ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pPage )
|
|
pPage = FindPageFrm();
|
|
|
|
OutputDevice *pOut = pGlobalShell->GetOut();
|
|
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *pOut );
|
|
|
|
// OD 2004-04-23 #116347#
|
|
pOut->Push( PUSH_FILLCOLOR|PUSH_LINECOLOR );
|
|
pOut->SetLineColor();
|
|
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)this );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
|
|
// OD 20.11.2002 #104598# - take care of page margin area
|
|
// Note: code move from <SwFrm::PaintBackground(..)> to new method
|
|
// <SwPageFrm::Paintmargin(..)>.
|
|
if ( IsPageFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
static_cast<const SwPageFrm*>(this)->PaintMarginArea( rRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// paint background
|
|
{
|
|
PaintBackground( rRect, pPage, rAttrs, sal_False, bLowerBorder );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - paint border before painting background
|
|
// paint grid for page frame and paint border
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
if( IsPageFrm() )
|
|
((SwPageFrm*)this)->PaintGrid( pOut, aRect );
|
|
PaintBorder( aRect, pPage, rAttrs );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
pOut->Pop();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::PaintBackground()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
/// OD 05.09.2002 #102912#
|
|
/// Do not paint background for fly frames without a background brush by
|
|
/// calling <PaintBaBo> at the page or at the fly frame its anchored
|
|
void SwFrm::PaintBackground( const SwRect &rRect, const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs & rAttrs,
|
|
const sal_Bool bLowerMode,
|
|
const sal_Bool bLowerBorder ) const
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 20.01.2003 #i1837# - no paint of table background, if corresponding
|
|
// option is *not* set.
|
|
if( IsTabFrm() &&
|
|
!pGlobalShell->GetViewOptions()->IsTable() )
|
|
{
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// nothing to do for covered table cells:
|
|
if( IsCellFrm() && IsCoveredCell() )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = pGlobalShell;
|
|
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
|
|
const SvxBrushItem* pItem;
|
|
/// OD 05.09.2002 #102912#
|
|
/// temporary background brush for a fly frame without a background brush
|
|
SvxBrushItem* pTmpBackBrush = 0;
|
|
const Color* pCol;
|
|
SwRect aOrigBackRect;
|
|
const sal_Bool bPageFrm = IsPageFrm();
|
|
sal_Bool bLowMode = sal_True;
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bBack = GetBackgroundBrush( pItem, pCol, aOrigBackRect, bLowerMode );
|
|
//- Ausgabe wenn ein eigener Hintergrund mitgebracht wird.
|
|
bool bNoFlyBackground = !bFlyMetafile && !bBack && IsFlyFrm();
|
|
if ( bNoFlyBackground )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 05.09.2002 #102912# - Fly frame has no background.
|
|
// Try to find background brush at parents, if previous call of
|
|
// <GetBackgroundBrush> disabled this option with the parameter <bLowerMode>
|
|
if ( bLowerMode )
|
|
{
|
|
bBack = GetBackgroundBrush( pItem, pCol, aOrigBackRect, false );
|
|
}
|
|
// If still no background found for the fly frame, initialize the
|
|
// background brush <pItem> with global retouche color and set <bBack>
|
|
// to sal_True, that fly frame will paint its background using this color.
|
|
if ( !bBack )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 10.01.2003 #i6467# - on print output, pdf output and
|
|
// in embedded mode not editing color COL_WHITE is used instead of
|
|
// the global retouche color.
|
|
if ( pSh->GetOut()->GetOutDevType() == OUTDEV_PRINTER ||
|
|
pSh->GetViewOptions()->IsPDFExport() ||
|
|
( pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell()->GetCreateMode() == SFX_CREATE_MODE_EMBEDDED &&
|
|
!pSh->GetDoc()->GetDocShell()->IsInPlaceActive()
|
|
)
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
pTmpBackBrush = new SvxBrushItem( Color( COL_WHITE ), RES_BACKGROUND );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
pTmpBackBrush = new SvxBrushItem( aGlobalRetoucheColor, RES_BACKGROUND);
|
|
}
|
|
pItem = pTmpBackBrush;
|
|
bBack = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aPaintRect( Frm() );
|
|
if( IsTxtFrm() || IsSctFrm() )
|
|
aPaintRect = UnionFrm( sal_True );
|
|
|
|
if ( aPaintRect.IsOver( rRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bBack || bPageFrm || !bLowerMode )
|
|
{
|
|
const sal_Bool bBrowse = pSh->GetViewOptions()->getBrowseMode();
|
|
SwRect aRect;
|
|
if ( (bPageFrm && bBrowse) ||
|
|
(IsTxtFrm() && Prt().SSize() == Frm().SSize()) )
|
|
{
|
|
aRect = Frm();
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( aRect, this, rAttrs, sal_False );
|
|
if ( (IsTxtFrm() || IsTabFrm()) && GetPrev() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( GetPrev()->GetAttrSet()->GetBackground() ==
|
|
GetAttrSet()->GetBackground() )
|
|
{
|
|
aRect.Top( Frm().Top() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
aRect.Intersection( rRect );
|
|
|
|
OutputDevice *pOut = pSh->GetOut();
|
|
|
|
if ( aRect.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
SvxBrushItem* pNewItem = 0;
|
|
SwRegionRects aRegion( aRect );
|
|
if( pCol )
|
|
{
|
|
pNewItem = new SvxBrushItem( *pCol, RES_BACKGROUND );
|
|
pItem = pNewItem;
|
|
}
|
|
if ( pPage->GetSortedObjs() )
|
|
::lcl_SubtractFlys( this, pPage, aRect, aRegion );
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - determine, if background transparency
|
|
/// have to be considered for drawing.
|
|
/// --> Status Quo: background transparency have to be
|
|
/// considered for fly frames
|
|
const sal_Bool bConsiderBackgroundTransparency = IsFlyFrm();
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( 1 < aRegion.Count() )
|
|
{
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aRegion[i], pGlobalShell );
|
|
if( !aRegion[i].HasArea() )
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
/// OD 06.08.2002 #99657# - add 6th parameter to indicate, if
|
|
/// background transparency have to be considered
|
|
/// Set missing 5th parameter to the default value GRFNUM_NO
|
|
/// - see declaration in /core/inc/frmtool.hxx.
|
|
::DrawGraphic( pItem, pOut, aOrigBackRect, aRegion[i], GRFNUM_NO,
|
|
bConsiderBackgroundTransparency );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if( pCol )
|
|
delete pNewItem;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
bLowMode = bLowerMode ? sal_True : sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// OD 05.09.2002 #102912#
|
|
/// delete temporary background brush.
|
|
delete pTmpBackBrush;
|
|
|
|
//Jetzt noch Lower und dessen Nachbarn.
|
|
//Wenn ein Frn dabei die Kette verlaesst also nicht mehr Lower von mir ist
|
|
//so hoert der Spass auf.
|
|
const SwFrm *pFrm = GetLower();
|
|
if ( pFrm )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aFrmRect;
|
|
SwRect aRect( PaintArea() );
|
|
aRect._Intersection( rRect );
|
|
SwRect aBorderRect( aRect );
|
|
SwShortCut aShortCut( *pFrm, aBorderRect );
|
|
do
|
|
{ if ( pProgress )
|
|
pProgress->Reschedule();
|
|
|
|
aFrmRect = pFrm->PaintArea();
|
|
if ( aFrmRect.IsOver( aBorderRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), (SwFrm*)pFrm );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rTmpAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
if ( ( pFrm->IsLayoutFrm() && bLowerBorder ) ||
|
|
aFrmRect.IsOver( aRect ) )
|
|
pFrm->PaintBackground( aRect, pPage, rTmpAttrs, bLowMode,
|
|
bLowerBorder );
|
|
if ( bLowerBorder )
|
|
pFrm->PaintBorder( aBorderRect, pPage, rTmpAttrs );
|
|
}
|
|
pFrm = pFrm->GetNext();
|
|
} while ( pFrm && pFrm->GetUpper() == this &&
|
|
!aShortCut.Stop( aFrmRect ) );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwPageFrm::RefreshSubsidiary()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Erneuert alle Hilfslinien der Seite.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::RefreshSubsidiary( const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( IS_SUBS || IS_SUBS_TABLE || IS_SUBS_SECTION || IS_SUBS_FLYS )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
// OD 18.02.2003 #104989# - Not necessary and incorrect alignment of
|
|
// the output rectangle.
|
|
//::SwAlignRect( aRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
if ( aRect.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
//Beim Paint ueber die Root wird das Array von dort gesteuert.
|
|
//Anderfalls kuemmern wir uns selbst darum.
|
|
sal_Bool bDelSubs = sal_False;
|
|
if ( !pSubsLines )
|
|
{
|
|
pSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
// OD 20.12.2002 #106318# - create container for special subsidiary lines
|
|
pSpecSubsLines = new SwSubsRects;
|
|
bDelSubs = sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
RefreshLaySubsidiary( this, aRect );
|
|
|
|
if ( bDelSubs )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 20.12.2002 #106318# - paint special subsidiary lines
|
|
// and delete its container
|
|
pSpecSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pGlobalShell->GetOut(), NULL );
|
|
DELETEZ( pSpecSubsLines );
|
|
|
|
pSubsLines->PaintSubsidiary( pGlobalShell->GetOut(), pLines );
|
|
DELETEZ( pSubsLines );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwLayoutFrm::RefreshLaySubsidiary()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
void SwLayoutFrm::RefreshLaySubsidiary( const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const sal_Bool bSubsOpt = IS_SUBS;
|
|
if ( bSubsOpt )
|
|
PaintSubsidiaryLines( pPage, rRect );
|
|
|
|
const SwFrm *pLow = Lower();
|
|
if( !pLow )
|
|
return;
|
|
SwShortCut aShortCut( *pLow, rRect );
|
|
while( pLow && !aShortCut.Stop( pLow->Frm() ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pLow->Frm().IsOver( rRect ) && pLow->Frm().HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pLow->IsLayoutFrm() )
|
|
((const SwLayoutFrm*)pLow)->RefreshLaySubsidiary( pPage, rRect);
|
|
else if ( pLow->GetDrawObjs() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwSortedObjs& rObjs = *(pLow->GetDrawObjs());
|
|
for ( sal_uInt32 i = 0; i < rObjs.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwAnchoredObject* pAnchoredObj = rObjs[i];
|
|
if ( pPage->GetFmt()->GetDoc()->IsVisibleLayerId(
|
|
pAnchoredObj->GetDrawObj()->GetLayer() ) &&
|
|
pAnchoredObj->ISA(SwFlyFrm) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pFly =
|
|
static_cast<const SwFlyFrm*>(pAnchoredObj);
|
|
if ( pFly->IsFlyInCntFrm() && pFly->Frm().IsOver( rRect ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pFly->Lower() || !pFly->Lower()->IsNoTxtFrm() ||
|
|
!((SwNoTxtFrm*)pFly->Lower())->HasAnimation())
|
|
pFly->RefreshLaySubsidiary( pPage, rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
pLow = pLow->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwLayoutFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Hilfslinien um die PrtAreas malen
|
|
|* Nur die LayoutFrm's die direkt Cntnt enthalten.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
//Malt die angegebene Linie, achtet darauf, dass keine Flys uebermalt werden.
|
|
|
|
typedef long Size::* SizePtr;
|
|
typedef long Point::* PointPtr;
|
|
|
|
PointPtr pX = &Point::nA;
|
|
PointPtr pY = &Point::nB;
|
|
SizePtr pWidth = &Size::nA;
|
|
SizePtr pHeight = &Size::nB;
|
|
|
|
// OD 18.11.2002 #99672# - new parameter <_pSubsLines>
|
|
void MA_FASTCALL lcl_RefreshLine( const SwLayoutFrm *pLay,
|
|
const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const Point &rP1,
|
|
const Point &rP2,
|
|
const sal_uInt8 nSubColor,
|
|
SwLineRects* _pSubsLines )
|
|
{
|
|
//In welche Richtung gehts? Kann nur Horizontal oder Vertikal sein.
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( ((rP1.X() == rP2.X()) || (rP1.Y() == rP2.Y())),
|
|
"Schraege Hilfslinien sind nicht erlaubt." );
|
|
const PointPtr pDirPt = rP1.X() == rP2.X() ? pY : pX;
|
|
const PointPtr pOthPt = pDirPt == pX ? pY : pX;
|
|
const SizePtr pDirSz = pDirPt == pX ? pWidth : pHeight;
|
|
const SizePtr pOthSz = pDirSz == pWidth ? pHeight : pWidth;
|
|
Point aP1( rP1 ),
|
|
aP2( rP2 );
|
|
|
|
while ( aP1.*pDirPt < aP2.*pDirPt )
|
|
{ //Der Startpunkt wird jetzt, falls er in einem Fly sitzt, direkt
|
|
//hinter den Fly gesetzt.
|
|
//Wenn der Endpunkt in einem Fly sitzt oder zwischen Start und Endpunkt
|
|
//ein Fly sitzt, so wird der Endpunkt eben an den Start herangezogen.
|
|
//Auf diese art und weise wird eine Portion nach der anderen
|
|
//ausgegeben.
|
|
|
|
//Wenn ich selbst ein Fly bin, weiche ich nur denjenigen Flys aus,
|
|
//die 'ueber' mir sitzen; d.h. die in dem Array hinter mir stehen.
|
|
//Auch wenn ich in einem Fly sitze oder in einem Fly im Fly usw. weiche
|
|
//ich keinem dieser Flys aus.
|
|
SwOrderIter aIter( pPage );
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pMyFly = pLay->FindFlyFrm();
|
|
if ( pMyFly )
|
|
{
|
|
aIter.Current( pMyFly->GetVirtDrawObj() );
|
|
while ( 0 != (pMyFly = pMyFly->GetAnchorFrm()->FindFlyFrm()) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aIter()->GetOrdNum() > pMyFly->GetVirtDrawObj()->GetOrdNum() )
|
|
aIter.Current( pMyFly->GetVirtDrawObj() );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
aIter.Bottom();
|
|
|
|
while ( aIter() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwVirtFlyDrawObj *pObj = (SwVirtFlyDrawObj*)aIter();
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pFly = pObj ? pObj->GetFlyFrm() : 0;
|
|
|
|
//Mir selbst weiche ich natuerlich nicht aus. Auch wenn ich
|
|
//_in_ dem Fly sitze weiche ich nicht aus.
|
|
if ( !pFly || (pFly == pLay || pFly->IsAnLower( pLay )) )
|
|
{
|
|
aIter.Next();
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// OD 19.12.2002 #106318# - do *not* consider fly frames with
|
|
// a transparent background.
|
|
// OD 2004-02-12 #110582#-2 - do *not* consider fly frame, which
|
|
// belongs to a invisible layer
|
|
if ( pFly->IsBackgroundTransparent() ||
|
|
!pFly->GetFmt()->GetDoc()->IsVisibleLayerId( pObj->GetLayer() ) )
|
|
{
|
|
aIter.Next();
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//Sitzt das Obj auf der Linie
|
|
const Rectangle &rBound = pObj->GetCurrentBoundRect();
|
|
const Point aDrPt( rBound.TopLeft() );
|
|
const Size aDrSz( rBound.GetSize() );
|
|
if ( rP1.*pOthPt >= aDrPt.*pOthPt &&
|
|
rP1.*pOthPt <= (aDrPt.*pOthPt + aDrSz.*pOthSz) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aP1.*pDirPt >= aDrPt.*pDirPt &&
|
|
aP1.*pDirPt <= (aDrPt.*pDirPt + aDrSz.*pDirSz) )
|
|
aP1.*pDirPt = aDrPt.*pDirPt + aDrSz.*pDirSz;
|
|
|
|
if ( aP2.*pDirPt >= aDrPt.*pDirPt &&
|
|
aP1.*pDirPt < (aDrPt.*pDirPt - 1) )
|
|
aP2.*pDirPt = aDrPt.*pDirPt - 1;
|
|
}
|
|
aIter.Next();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( aP1.*pDirPt < aP2.*pDirPt )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aRect( aP1, aP2 );
|
|
// OD 18.11.2002 #99672# - use parameter <_pSubsLines> instead of
|
|
// global variable <pSubsLines>.
|
|
_pSubsLines->AddLineRect( aRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSubColor );
|
|
}
|
|
aP1 = aP2;
|
|
aP1.*pDirPt += 1;
|
|
aP2 = rP2;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence lcl_CreatePageAreaDelimiterPrimitives(
|
|
const SwRect& rRect )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSeq( 4 );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::BColor aLineColor = SwViewOption::GetDocBoundariesColor().getBColor();
|
|
double nLineLength = 200.0; // in Twips
|
|
|
|
Point aPoints[] = { rRect.TopLeft(), rRect.TopRight(), rRect.BottomRight(), rRect.BottomLeft() };
|
|
double aXOffDirs[] = { -1.0, 1.0, 1.0, -1.0 };
|
|
double aYOffDirs[] = { -1.0, -1.0, 1.0, 1.0 };
|
|
|
|
// Actually loop over the corners to create the two lines
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < 4; i++ )
|
|
{
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aHorizVector( aXOffDirs[i], 0.0 );
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aVertVector( 0.0, aYOffDirs[i] );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aBPoint( aPoints[i].X(), aPoints[i].Y() );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPolygon aPolygon;
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint + aHorizVector * nLineLength );
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint );
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint + aVertVector * nLineLength );
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D* pLine =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D(
|
|
aPolygon, aLineColor );
|
|
aSeq[i] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pLine );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return aSeq;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence lcl_CreateColumnAreaDelimiterPrimitives(
|
|
const SwRect& rRect )
|
|
{
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DSequence aSeq( 4 );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::BColor aLineColor = SwViewOption::GetDocBoundariesColor().getBColor();
|
|
double nLineLength = 100.0; // in Twips
|
|
|
|
Point aPoints[] = { rRect.TopLeft(), rRect.TopRight(), rRect.BottomRight(), rRect.BottomLeft() };
|
|
double aXOffDirs[] = { 1.0, -1.0, -1.0, 1.0 };
|
|
double aYOffDirs[] = { 1.0, 1.0, -1.0, -1.0 };
|
|
|
|
// Actually loop over the corners to create the two lines
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < 4; i++ )
|
|
{
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aHorizVector( aXOffDirs[i], 0.0 );
|
|
basegfx::B2DVector aVertVector( 0.0, aYOffDirs[i] );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPoint aBPoint( aPoints[i].X(), aPoints[i].Y() );
|
|
|
|
basegfx::B2DPolygon aPolygon;
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint + aHorizVector * nLineLength );
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint );
|
|
aPolygon.append( aBPoint + aVertVector * nLineLength );
|
|
|
|
drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D* pLine =
|
|
new drawinglayer::primitive2d::PolygonHairlinePrimitive2D(
|
|
aPolygon, aLineColor );
|
|
aSeq[i] = drawinglayer::primitive2d::Primitive2DReference( pLine );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return aSeq;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *,
|
|
const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( !pGlobalShell->IsHeaderFooterEdit() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pLay = Lower();
|
|
const SwFrm* pFtnCont = NULL;
|
|
const SwFrm* pPageBody = NULL;
|
|
while ( pLay && !( pFtnCont && pPageBody ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pLay->IsFtnContFrm( ) )
|
|
pFtnCont = pLay;
|
|
if ( pLay->IsBodyFrm() )
|
|
pPageBody = pLay;
|
|
pLay = pLay->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aArea( pPageBody->Frm() );
|
|
if ( pFtnCont )
|
|
aArea.AddBottom( pFtnCont->Frm().Bottom() - aArea.Bottom() );
|
|
|
|
ProcessPrimitives( lcl_CreatePageAreaDelimiterPrimitives( aArea ) );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
PaintBreak();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwColumnFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *,
|
|
const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm* pLay = Lower();
|
|
const SwFrm* pFtnCont = NULL;
|
|
const SwFrm* pColBody = NULL;
|
|
while ( pLay && !( pFtnCont && pColBody ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pLay->IsFtnContFrm( ) )
|
|
pFtnCont = pLay;
|
|
if ( pLay->IsBodyFrm() )
|
|
pColBody = pLay;
|
|
pLay = pLay->GetNext();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SwRect aArea( pColBody->Frm() );
|
|
|
|
// #i3662# - enlarge top of column body frame's printing area
|
|
// in sections to top of section frame.
|
|
const bool bColInSection = GetUpper()->IsSctFrm();
|
|
if ( bColInSection )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( IsVertical() )
|
|
aArea.Right( GetUpper()->Frm().Right() );
|
|
else
|
|
aArea.Top( GetUpper()->Frm().Top() );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( pFtnCont )
|
|
aArea.AddBottom( pFtnCont->Frm().Bottom() - aArea.Bottom() );
|
|
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aArea, pGlobalShell );
|
|
|
|
ProcessPrimitives( lcl_CreateColumnAreaDelimiterPrimitives( aArea ) );
|
|
|
|
PaintBreak();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwSectionFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm * pPage,
|
|
const SwRect & rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const sal_Bool bNoLowerColumn = !Lower() || !Lower()->IsColumnFrm();
|
|
if ( bNoLowerColumn )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLayoutFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( pPage, rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** The SwBodyFrm doesn't print any subsidiary line: it's bounds are painted
|
|
either by the parent page or the parent column frame.
|
|
*/
|
|
void SwBodyFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *,
|
|
const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwHeadFootFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *, const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pGlobalShell->IsHeaderFooterEdit() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect aArea( Prt() );
|
|
aArea.Pos() += Frm().Pos();
|
|
ProcessPrimitives( lcl_CreatePageAreaDelimiterPrimitives( aArea ) );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** This method is overridden in order to have no subsidiary lines
|
|
around the footnotes.
|
|
*/
|
|
void SwFtnFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *,
|
|
const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** This method is overridden in order to have no subsidiary lines
|
|
around the footnotes containers.
|
|
*/
|
|
void SwFtnContFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *,
|
|
const SwRect & ) const
|
|
{
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLayoutFrm::PaintSubsidiaryLines( const SwPageFrm *pPage,
|
|
const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
bool bNewTableModel = false;
|
|
|
|
// #i29550#
|
|
if ( IsTabFrm() || IsCellFrm() || IsRowFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwTabFrm* pTabFrm = FindTabFrm();
|
|
if ( pTabFrm->IsCollapsingBorders() )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
bNewTableModel = pTabFrm->GetTable()->IsNewModel();
|
|
// in the new table model, we have an early return for all cell-related
|
|
// frames, except from non-covered table cells
|
|
if ( bNewTableModel )
|
|
if ( IsTabFrm() ||
|
|
IsRowFrm() ||
|
|
( IsCellFrm() && IsCoveredCell() ) )
|
|
return;
|
|
}
|
|
// <-- collapsing
|
|
|
|
const bool bFlys = pPage->GetSortedObjs() ? true : false;
|
|
|
|
const bool bCell = IsCellFrm() ? true : false;
|
|
// use frame area for cells
|
|
// OD 13.02.2003 #i3662# - for section use also frame area
|
|
const bool bUseFrmArea = bCell || IsSctFrm();
|
|
SwRect aOriginal( bUseFrmArea ? Frm() : Prt() );
|
|
if ( !bUseFrmArea )
|
|
aOriginal.Pos() += Frm().Pos();
|
|
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aOriginal, pGlobalShell );
|
|
|
|
if ( !aOriginal.IsOver( rRect ) )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
SwRect aOut( aOriginal );
|
|
aOut._Intersection( rRect );
|
|
|
|
const SwTwips nRight = aOut.Right();
|
|
const SwTwips nBottom= aOut.Bottom();
|
|
|
|
const Point aRT( nRight, aOut.Top() );
|
|
const Point aRB( nRight, nBottom );
|
|
const Point aLB( aOut.Left(), nBottom );
|
|
|
|
sal_uInt8 nSubColor = ( bCell || IsRowFrm() ) ? SUBCOL_TAB :
|
|
( IsInSct() ? SUBCOL_SECT :
|
|
( IsInFly() ? SUBCOL_FLY : SUBCOL_PAGE ) );
|
|
|
|
// OD 18.11.2002 #99672# - collect body, header, footer, footnote and section
|
|
// sub-lines in <pSpecSubsLine> array.
|
|
const bool bSpecialSublines = IsBodyFrm() || IsHeaderFrm() || IsFooterFrm() ||
|
|
IsFtnFrm() || IsSctFrm();
|
|
SwLineRects* pUsedSubsLines = bSpecialSublines ? pSpecSubsLines : pSubsLines;
|
|
|
|
// NOTE: for cell frames only left and right (horizontal layout) respectively
|
|
// top and bottom (vertical layout) lines painted.
|
|
// NOTE2: this does not hold for the new table model!!! We paint the top border
|
|
// of each non-covered table cell.
|
|
const bool bVert = IsVertical() ? true : false;
|
|
if ( bFlys )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104822# - add control for drawing left and right lines
|
|
if ( !bCell || bNewTableModel || !bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Left() == aOut.Left() )
|
|
::lcl_RefreshLine( this, pPage, aOut.Pos(), aLB, nSubColor, pUsedSubsLines );
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104821# - in vertical layout set page/column break at right
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Right() == nRight )
|
|
::lcl_RefreshLine( this, pPage, aRT, aRB, nSubColor, pUsedSubsLines );
|
|
}
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104822# - adjust control for drawing top and bottom lines
|
|
if ( !bCell || bNewTableModel || bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Top() == aOut.Top() )
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104821# - in horizontal layout set page/column break at top
|
|
::lcl_RefreshLine( this, pPage, aOut.Pos(), aRT, nSubColor, pUsedSubsLines );
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Bottom() == nBottom )
|
|
::lcl_RefreshLine( this, pPage, aLB, aRB, nSubColor,
|
|
pUsedSubsLines );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104822# - add control for drawing left and right lines
|
|
if ( !bCell || bNewTableModel || !bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Left() == aOut.Left() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwRect aRect( aOut.Pos(), aLB );
|
|
pUsedSubsLines->AddLineRect( aRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSubColor );
|
|
}
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104821# - in vertical layout set page/column break at right
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Right() == nRight )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwRect aRect( aRT, aRB );
|
|
pUsedSubsLines->AddLineRect( aRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSubColor );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104822# - adjust control for drawing top and bottom lines
|
|
if ( !bCell || bNewTableModel || bVert )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Top() == aOut.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
// OD 14.11.2002 #104821# - in horizontal layout set page/column break at top
|
|
const SwRect aRect( aOut.Pos(), aRT );
|
|
pUsedSubsLines->AddLineRect( aRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSubColor );
|
|
}
|
|
if ( aOriginal.Bottom() == nBottom )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwRect aRect( aLB, aRB );
|
|
pUsedSubsLines->AddLineRect( aRect, 0, SOLID, 0, nSubColor );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwPageFrm::RefreshExtraData(), SwLayoutFrm::RefreshExtraData()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Erneuert alle Extradaten (Zeilennummern usw) der Seite.
|
|
|* Grundsaetzlich sind nur diejenigen Objekte beruecksichtig,
|
|
|* die in die seitliche Ausdehnung des Rects ragen.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwPageFrm::RefreshExtraData( const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const SwLineNumberInfo &rInfo = GetFmt()->GetDoc()->GetLineNumberInfo();
|
|
sal_Bool bLineInFly = (rInfo.IsPaintLineNumbers() && rInfo.IsCountInFlys())
|
|
|| (sal_Int16)SW_MOD()->GetRedlineMarkPos() != text::HoriOrientation::NONE;
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRect( rRect );
|
|
::SwAlignRect( aRect, pGlobalShell );
|
|
if ( aRect.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwLayoutFrm::RefreshExtraData( aRect );
|
|
|
|
if ( bLineInFly && GetSortedObjs() )
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < GetSortedObjs()->Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwAnchoredObject* pAnchoredObj = (*GetSortedObjs())[i];
|
|
if ( pAnchoredObj->ISA(SwFlyFrm) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pFly = static_cast<const SwFlyFrm*>(pAnchoredObj);
|
|
if ( pFly->Frm().Top() <= aRect.Bottom() &&
|
|
pFly->Frm().Bottom() >= aRect.Top() )
|
|
pFly->RefreshExtraData( aRect );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
void SwLayoutFrm::RefreshExtraData( const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const SwLineNumberInfo &rInfo = GetFmt()->GetDoc()->GetLineNumberInfo();
|
|
sal_Bool bLineInBody = rInfo.IsPaintLineNumbers(),
|
|
bLineInFly = bLineInBody && rInfo.IsCountInFlys(),
|
|
bRedLine = (sal_Int16)SW_MOD()->GetRedlineMarkPos()!=text::HoriOrientation::NONE;
|
|
|
|
const SwCntntFrm *pCnt = ContainsCntnt();
|
|
while ( pCnt && IsAnLower( pCnt ) )
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pCnt->IsTxtFrm() && ( bRedLine ||
|
|
( !pCnt->IsInTab() &&
|
|
((bLineInBody && pCnt->IsInDocBody()) ||
|
|
(bLineInFly && pCnt->IsInFly())) ) ) &&
|
|
pCnt->Frm().Top() <= rRect.Bottom() &&
|
|
pCnt->Frm().Bottom() >= rRect.Top() )
|
|
{
|
|
((SwTxtFrm*)pCnt)->PaintExtraData( rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
if ( bLineInFly && pCnt->GetDrawObjs() )
|
|
for ( sal_uInt32 i = 0; i < pCnt->GetDrawObjs()->Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwAnchoredObject* pAnchoredObj = (*pCnt->GetDrawObjs())[i];
|
|
if ( pAnchoredObj->ISA(SwFlyFrm) )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFlyFrm *pFly = static_cast<const SwFlyFrm*>(pAnchoredObj);
|
|
if ( pFly->IsFlyInCntFrm() &&
|
|
pFly->Frm().Top() <= rRect.Bottom() &&
|
|
pFly->Frm().Bottom() >= rRect.Top() )
|
|
pFly->RefreshExtraData( rRect );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
pCnt = pCnt->GetNextCntntFrm();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** SwPageFrm::GetDrawBackgrdColor - for #102450#
|
|
|
|
determine the color, that is respectively will be drawn as background
|
|
for the page frame.
|
|
Using existing method SwFrm::GetBackgroundBrush to determine the color
|
|
that is set at the page frame respectively is parent. If none is found
|
|
return the global retouche color
|
|
|
|
@author OD
|
|
|
|
@return Color
|
|
*/
|
|
const Color& SwPageFrm::GetDrawBackgrdColor() const
|
|
{
|
|
const SvxBrushItem* pBrushItem;
|
|
const Color* pDummyColor;
|
|
SwRect aDummyRect;
|
|
if ( GetBackgroundBrush( pBrushItem, pDummyColor, aDummyRect, true) )
|
|
return pBrushItem->GetColor();
|
|
else
|
|
return aGlobalRetoucheColor;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwPageFrm::GetEmptyPageFont()
|
|
|*
|
|
|* create/return font used to paint the "empty page" string
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
const Font& SwPageFrm::GetEmptyPageFont()
|
|
{
|
|
static Font* pEmptyPgFont = 0;
|
|
if ( 0 == pEmptyPgFont )
|
|
{
|
|
pEmptyPgFont = new Font;
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetSize( Size( 0, 80 * 20 )); // == 80 pt
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetWeight( WEIGHT_BOLD );
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetStyleName( aEmptyStr );
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetName( String::CreateFromAscii(
|
|
RTL_CONSTASCII_STRINGPARAM( "Helvetica" )) );
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetFamily( FAMILY_SWISS );
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetTransparent( sal_True );
|
|
pEmptyPgFont->SetColor( COL_GRAY );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return *pEmptyPgFont;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrm::Retouche
|
|
|*
|
|
|* Beschreibung Retouche fuer einen Bereich.
|
|
|* Retouche wird nur dann durchgefuehrt, wenn der Frm der letzte seiner
|
|
|* Kette ist. Der Gesamte Bereich des Upper unterhalb des Frm wird
|
|
|* per PaintBackground gecleared.
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SwFrm::Retouche( const SwPageFrm * pPage, const SwRect &rRect ) const
|
|
{
|
|
if ( bFlyMetafile )
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( GetUpper(), "Retoucheversuch ohne Upper." );
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell() && pGlobalShell->GetWin(), "Retouche auf dem Drucker?" );
|
|
|
|
SwRect aRetouche( GetUpper()->PaintArea() );
|
|
aRetouche.Top( Frm().Top() + Frm().Height() );
|
|
aRetouche.Intersection( pGlobalShell->VisArea() );
|
|
|
|
if ( aRetouche.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
//Uebergebenes Rect ausparen. Dafuer brauchen wir leider eine Region
|
|
//zum ausstanzen.
|
|
SwRegionRects aRegion( aRetouche );
|
|
aRegion -= rRect;
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
|
|
// #i16816# tagged pdf support
|
|
SwTaggedPDFHelper aTaggedPDFHelper( 0, 0, 0, *pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
|
|
for ( sal_uInt16 i = 0; i < aRegion.Count(); ++i )
|
|
{
|
|
SwRect &rRetouche = aRegion[i];
|
|
|
|
GetUpper()->PaintBaBo( rRetouche, pPage, sal_True );
|
|
|
|
//Hoelle und Himmel muessen auch refreshed werden.
|
|
//Um Rekursionen zu vermeiden muss mein Retouche Flag zuerst
|
|
//zurueckgesetzt werden!
|
|
ResetRetouche();
|
|
SwRect aRetouchePart( rRetouche );
|
|
if ( aRetouchePart.HasArea() )
|
|
{
|
|
const Color aPageBackgrdColor = pPage->GetDrawBackgrdColor();
|
|
const IDocumentDrawModelAccess* pIDDMA = pSh->getIDocumentDrawModelAccess();
|
|
// --> OD #i76669#
|
|
SwViewObjectContactRedirector aSwRedirector( *pSh );
|
|
// <--
|
|
|
|
pSh->Imp()->PaintLayer( pIDDMA->GetHellId(), 0,
|
|
aRetouchePart, &aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
pSh->Imp()->PaintLayer( pIDDMA->GetHeavenId(), 0,
|
|
aRetouchePart, &aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SetRetouche();
|
|
|
|
//Da wir uns ausserhalb aller Paint-Bereiche begeben muessen hier
|
|
//leider die Hilfslinien erneuert werden.
|
|
pPage->RefreshSubsidiary( aRetouchePart );
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if ( ViewShell::IsLstEndAction() )
|
|
ResetRetouche();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/** SwFrm::GetBackgroundBrush
|
|
|
|
@descr
|
|
determine the background brush for the frame:
|
|
the background brush is taken from it-self or from its parent (anchor/upper).
|
|
Normally, the background brush is taken, which has no transparent color or
|
|
which has a background graphic. But there are some special cases:
|
|
(1) No background brush is taken from a page frame, if view option "IsPageBack"
|
|
isn't set.
|
|
(2) Background brush from a index section is taken under special conditions.
|
|
In this case parameter <rpCol> is set to the index shading color.
|
|
(3) New (OD 20.08.2002) - Background brush is taken, if on background drawing
|
|
of the frame transparency is considered and its color is not "no fill"/"auto fill"
|
|
---- old description in german:
|
|
Beschreibung Liefert die Backgroundbrush fuer den Bereich des
|
|
des Frm. Die Brush wird entweder von ihm selbst oder von einem
|
|
Upper vorgegeben, die erste Brush wird benutzt.
|
|
Ist fuer keinen Frm eine Brush angegeben, so wird sal_False zurueck-
|
|
geliefert.
|
|
|
|
@param rpBrush
|
|
output parameter - constant reference pointer the found background brush
|
|
|
|
@param rpCol
|
|
output parameter - constant reference pointer to the color of the index shading
|
|
set under special conditions, if background brush is taken from an index section.
|
|
|
|
@param rOrigRect
|
|
in-/output parameter - reference to the retangle the background brush is
|
|
considered for - adjusted to the frame, from which the background brush is
|
|
taken.
|
|
|
|
@parem bLowerMode
|
|
input parameter - boolean indicating, if background brush should *not* be
|
|
taken from parent.
|
|
|
|
@return true, if a background brush for the frame is found
|
|
*/
|
|
sal_Bool SwFrm::GetBackgroundBrush( const SvxBrushItem* & rpBrush,
|
|
const Color*& rpCol,
|
|
SwRect &rOrigRect,
|
|
sal_Bool bLowerMode ) const
|
|
{
|
|
const SwFrm *pFrm = this;
|
|
ViewShell *pSh = getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell();
|
|
const SwViewOption *pOpt = pSh->GetViewOptions();
|
|
rpBrush = 0;
|
|
rpCol = NULL;
|
|
do
|
|
{ if ( pFrm->IsPageFrm() && !pOpt->IsPageBack() )
|
|
return sal_False;
|
|
|
|
const SvxBrushItem &rBack = pFrm->GetAttrSet()->GetBackground();
|
|
if( pFrm->IsSctFrm() )
|
|
{
|
|
const SwSection* pSection = ((SwSectionFrm*)pFrm)->GetSection();
|
|
/// OD 20.08.2002 #99657# #GetTransChg#
|
|
/// Note: If frame <pFrm> is a section of the index and
|
|
/// it its background color is "no fill"/"auto fill" and
|
|
/// it has no background graphic and
|
|
/// we are not in the page preview and
|
|
/// we are not in read-only mode and
|
|
/// option "index shadings" is set and
|
|
/// the output is not the printer
|
|
/// then set <rpCol> to the color of the index shading
|
|
if( pSection && ( TOX_HEADER_SECTION == pSection->GetType() ||
|
|
TOX_CONTENT_SECTION == pSection->GetType() ) &&
|
|
(rBack.GetColor() == COL_TRANSPARENT) &&
|
|
///rBack.GetColor().GetTransparency() &&
|
|
rBack.GetGraphicPos() == GPOS_NONE &&
|
|
!pOpt->IsPagePreview() &&
|
|
!pOpt->IsReadonly() &&
|
|
// #114856# Formular view
|
|
!pOpt->IsFormView() &&
|
|
SwViewOption::IsIndexShadings() &&
|
|
!pOpt->IsPDFExport() &&
|
|
pSh->GetOut()->GetOutDevType() != OUTDEV_PRINTER )
|
|
{
|
|
rpCol = &SwViewOption::GetIndexShadingsColor();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// OD 20.08.2002 #99657#
|
|
/// determine, if background draw of frame <pFrm> considers transparency
|
|
/// --> Status Quo: background transparency have to be
|
|
/// considered for fly frames
|
|
const sal_Bool bConsiderBackgroundTransparency = pFrm->IsFlyFrm();
|
|
/// OD 20.08.2002 #99657#
|
|
/// add condition:
|
|
/// If <bConsiderBackgroundTransparency> is set - see above -,
|
|
/// return brush of frame <pFrm>, if its color is *not* "no fill"/"auto fill"
|
|
if ( !rBack.GetColor().GetTransparency() ||
|
|
rBack.GetGraphicPos() != GPOS_NONE ||
|
|
rpCol ||
|
|
(bConsiderBackgroundTransparency && (rBack.GetColor() != COL_TRANSPARENT))
|
|
)
|
|
{
|
|
rpBrush = &rBack;
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsPageFrm() &&
|
|
pSh->GetViewOptions()->getBrowseMode() )
|
|
rOrigRect = pFrm->Frm();
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
if ( pFrm->Frm().SSize() != pFrm->Prt().SSize() )
|
|
{
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), pFrm );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
::lcl_CalcBorderRect( rOrigRect, pFrm, rAttrs, sal_False );
|
|
}
|
|
else
|
|
{
|
|
rOrigRect = pFrm->Prt();
|
|
rOrigRect += pFrm->Frm().Pos();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return sal_True;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if ( bLowerMode )
|
|
/// Do not try to get background brush from parent (anchor/upper)
|
|
return sal_False;
|
|
|
|
/// get parent frame - anchor or upper - for next loop
|
|
if ( pFrm->IsFlyFrm() )
|
|
/// OD 20.08.2002 - use "static_cast" instead of "old C-cast"
|
|
pFrm = (static_cast<const SwFlyFrm*>(pFrm))->GetAnchorFrm();
|
|
///pFrm = ((SwFlyFrm*)pFrm)->GetAnchor();
|
|
else
|
|
pFrm = pFrm->GetUpper();
|
|
|
|
} while ( pFrm );
|
|
|
|
return sal_False;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/*************************************************************************
|
|
|*
|
|
|* SwFrmFmt::GetGraphic()
|
|
|*
|
|
|*************************************************************************/
|
|
|
|
void SetOutDevAndWin( ViewShell *pSh, OutputDevice *pO,
|
|
Window *pW, sal_uInt16 nZoom )
|
|
{
|
|
pSh->pOut = pO;
|
|
pSh->pWin = pW;
|
|
pSh->pOpt->SetZoom( nZoom );
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Graphic SwFrmFmt::MakeGraphic( ImageMap* )
|
|
{
|
|
return Graphic();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Graphic SwFlyFrmFmt::MakeGraphic( ImageMap* pMap )
|
|
{
|
|
Graphic aRet;
|
|
//irgendeinen Fly suchen!
|
|
SwIterator<SwFrm,SwFmt> aIter( *this );
|
|
SwFrm *pFirst = aIter.First();
|
|
ViewShell *pSh;
|
|
if ( pFirst && 0 != ( pSh = pFirst->getRootFrm()->GetCurrShell()) )
|
|
{
|
|
ViewShell *pOldGlobal = pGlobalShell;
|
|
pGlobalShell = pSh;
|
|
|
|
sal_Bool bNoteURL = pMap &&
|
|
SFX_ITEM_SET != GetAttrSet().GetItemState( RES_URL, sal_True );
|
|
if( bNoteURL )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( !pNoteURL, "MakeGraphic: pNoteURL already used? " );
|
|
pNoteURL = new SwNoteURL;
|
|
}
|
|
SwFlyFrm *pFly = (SwFlyFrm*)pFirst;
|
|
|
|
OutputDevice *pOld = pSh->GetOut();
|
|
VirtualDevice aDev( *pOld );
|
|
aDev.EnableOutput( sal_False );
|
|
|
|
GDIMetaFile aMet;
|
|
MapMode aMap( pOld->GetMapMode().GetMapUnit() );
|
|
aDev.SetMapMode( aMap );
|
|
aMet.SetPrefMapMode( aMap );
|
|
|
|
::SwCalcPixStatics( pSh->GetOut() );
|
|
aMet.SetPrefSize( pFly->Frm().SSize() );
|
|
|
|
aMet.Record( &aDev );
|
|
aDev.SetLineColor();
|
|
aDev.SetFillColor();
|
|
aDev.SetFont( pOld->GetFont() );
|
|
|
|
//Rechteck ggf. ausdehnen, damit die Umrandunge mit aufgezeichnet werden.
|
|
SwRect aOut( pFly->Frm() );
|
|
SwBorderAttrAccess aAccess( SwFrm::GetCache(), pFly );
|
|
const SwBorderAttrs &rAttrs = *aAccess.Get();
|
|
if ( rAttrs.CalcRightLine() )
|
|
aOut.SSize().Width() += 2*nPixelSzW;
|
|
if ( rAttrs.CalcBottomLine() )
|
|
aOut.SSize().Height()+= 2*nPixelSzH;
|
|
|
|
// #i92711# start Pre/PostPaint encapsulation before pOut is changed to the buffering VDev
|
|
const Region aRepaintRegion(aOut.SVRect());
|
|
pSh->DLPrePaint2(aRepaintRegion);
|
|
|
|
Window *pWin = pSh->GetWin();
|
|
sal_uInt16 nZoom = pSh->GetViewOptions()->GetZoom();
|
|
::SetOutDevAndWin( pSh, &aDev, 0, 100 );
|
|
bFlyMetafile = sal_True;
|
|
pFlyMetafileOut = pWin;
|
|
|
|
SwViewImp *pImp = pSh->Imp();
|
|
pFlyOnlyDraw = pFly;
|
|
pLines = new SwLineRects;
|
|
|
|
// OD 09.12.2002 #103045# - determine page, fly frame is on
|
|
const SwPageFrm* pFlyPage = pFly->FindPageFrm();
|
|
const Color aPageBackgrdColor = pFlyPage->GetDrawBackgrdColor();
|
|
const IDocumentDrawModelAccess* pIDDMA = pSh->getIDocumentDrawModelAccess();
|
|
// --> OD #i76669#
|
|
SwViewObjectContactRedirector aSwRedirector( *pSh );
|
|
// <--
|
|
pImp->PaintLayer( pIDDMA->GetHellId(), 0, aOut, &aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pFlyPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( &aDev );
|
|
if ( pFly->IsFlyInCntFrm() )
|
|
pFly->Paint( aOut );
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( &aDev );
|
|
/// OD 30.08.2002 #102450# - add 3rd parameter
|
|
pImp->PaintLayer( pIDDMA->GetHeavenId(), 0, aOut, &aPageBackgrdColor,
|
|
(pFlyPage->IsRightToLeft() ? true : false),
|
|
&aSwRedirector );
|
|
pLines->PaintLines( &aDev );
|
|
DELETEZ( pLines );
|
|
pFlyOnlyDraw = 0;
|
|
|
|
pFlyMetafileOut = 0;
|
|
bFlyMetafile = sal_False;
|
|
::SetOutDevAndWin( pSh, pOld, pWin, nZoom );
|
|
|
|
// #i92711# end Pre/PostPaint encapsulation when pOut is back and content is painted
|
|
pSh->DLPostPaint2(true);
|
|
|
|
aMet.Stop();
|
|
aMet.Move( -pFly->Frm().Left(), -pFly->Frm().Top() );
|
|
aRet = Graphic( aMet );
|
|
|
|
if( bNoteURL )
|
|
{
|
|
OSL_ENSURE( pNoteURL, "MakeGraphic: Good Bye, NoteURL." );
|
|
pNoteURL->FillImageMap( pMap, pFly->Frm().Pos(), aMap );
|
|
delete pNoteURL;
|
|
pNoteURL = NULL;
|
|
}
|
|
pGlobalShell = pOldGlobal;
|
|
}
|
|
return aRet;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Graphic SwDrawFrmFmt::MakeGraphic( ImageMap* )
|
|
{
|
|
Graphic aRet;
|
|
SdrModel *pMod = getIDocumentDrawModelAccess()->GetDrawModel();
|
|
if ( pMod )
|
|
{
|
|
SdrObject *pObj = FindSdrObject();
|
|
SdrView *pView = new SdrView( pMod );
|
|
SdrPageView *pPgView = pView->ShowSdrPage(pView->GetModel()->GetPage(0));
|
|
pView->MarkObj( pObj, pPgView );
|
|
aRet = pView->GetMarkedObjBitmap();
|
|
pView->HideSdrPage();
|
|
delete pView;
|
|
}
|
|
return aRet;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/* vim:set shiftwidth=4 softtabstop=4 expandtab: */
|